blob: 336ef1fd3f69f733438027f4bffdb19780f774af [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaub3066502017-11-26 19:50:17 +01005 version 1.9
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau27010f02018-09-29 20:17:33 +02007 2018/09/29
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011210.1. Limitation
11310.2. Setup
11410.2.1. Cache section
11510.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116
1171. Quick reminder about HTTP
118----------------------------
119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
122on almost anything found in the contents.
123
124However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
125formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
126correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
127
128
1291.1. The HTTP transaction model
130-------------------------------
131
132The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100133to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
135connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136will involve a new connection :
137
138 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
139
140In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
141establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
142by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
143length.
144
145Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
146to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
147however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
148response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
149header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
154power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
155but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200156a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100158Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
160second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
161page :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
166latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
167correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
168the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100169server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
172time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
173are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
174parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
175carry the stream identifier.
176
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100177By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
178connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
179leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
181processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
182waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100184HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
185 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
186 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
187 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
188 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
190 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
586 - ssl-default-bind-options
587 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
588 - ssl-default-server-options
589 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100590 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100591 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100592 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100593 - 51degrees-data-file
594 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200595 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200596 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100597 - wurfl-data-file
598 - wurfl-information-list
599 - wurfl-information-list-separator
600 - wurfl-engine-mode
601 - wurfl-cache-size
602 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200605 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200607 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100608 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100609 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100610 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200611 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200612 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200613 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - noepoll
616 - nokqueue
617 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100618 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300619 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000620 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200621 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200622 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200623 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000624 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000625 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - tune.buffers.limit
627 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200628 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200629 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100630 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200631 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200632 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200633 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100634 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200635 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200636 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100637 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100639 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.session-timeout
641 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200642 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100643 - tune.maxaccept
644 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200645 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200646 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200647 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100648 - tune.rcvbuf.client
649 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100650 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200651 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100652 - tune.sndbuf.client
653 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100654 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100655 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200656 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200658 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200659 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100660 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200661 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100662 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
664 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
665 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100666 - tune.zlib.memlevel
667 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100668
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200669 * Debugging
670 - debug
671 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672
673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006743.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675------------------------------------
676
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200677ca-base <dir>
678 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200679 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
680 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200682chroot <jail dir>
683 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
684 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
685 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
686 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
687 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100688 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100689
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100690cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
691 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
692 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
693 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
694 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
695 set. These sets have the format
696
697 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
698
699 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100700 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100701 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
702 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100703 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
704 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100705 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100707 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
710 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
711 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
712 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100713
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100714 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
715 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
716 on the machine's word size.
717
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100718 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100719 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
720 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
721 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
722 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
723 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
724 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100725
726 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100727 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
728
729 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
730 # first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
733 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
734 # word size.
735
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100736 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100737 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
739 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
740 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
741
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
743 # and so on.
744 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
745 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
747
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100749 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
750 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
751 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
752
753 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
754 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
755 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
756
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
758 # and a thread range.
759 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
760 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
761 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
762
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200763crt-base <dir>
764 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
765 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
766 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768daemon
769 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
770 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100771 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
772 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200774deviceatlas-json-file <path>
775 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100776 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777
778deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
781
782deviceatlas-separator <char>
783 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
784 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
785
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100786deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200787 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
788 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
789 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100790
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900791external-check
792 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
793 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
794 See "option external-check".
795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796gid <number>
797 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
798 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
799 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100800 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
801 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100803
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100804hard-stop-after <time>
805 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
806
807 Arguments :
808 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
809 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
810 SIGUSR1 signal.
811
812 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
813 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
814 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
815
816 Example:
817 global
818 hard-stop-after 30s
819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820group <group name>
821 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
822 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100823
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200824log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100825 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100826 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100827 configured with "log global".
828
829 <address> can be one of:
830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100831 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100832 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
833 port).
834
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100835 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
836 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
837 port).
838
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100839 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
840 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
841 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100842 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200844 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
845 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100846
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200847 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
848 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
849 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
850 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
851 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
852 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
853 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
854 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
855 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
856 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100857 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
858 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200859
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200860 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
861 one of the following :
862
863 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
864 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
865
866 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
867 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
868
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100869 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200870
871 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
872 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
873 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
874
875 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200876 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
877 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
878 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
879 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
880 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
881 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200882
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200883 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200884
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100885log-send-hostname [<string>]
886 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
887 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
888 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
889 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
890 the logs.
891
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000892log-tag <string>
893 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
894 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
895 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100896 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000897
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100898lua-load <file>
899 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
900 used multiple times.
901
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100902master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200903 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
904 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
905 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100906 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200907 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
908 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100909 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
910 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
911 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
912 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
913 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200914
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100915 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200916
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917nbproc <number>
918 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
919 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
920 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
921 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
922 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
923
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200924nbthread <number>
925 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
926 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
927 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
928 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
929 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200931pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100932 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200933 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
934 starting the process. See also "daemon".
935
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100936presetenv <name> <value>
937 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
938 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
939 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
940 and "unsetenv".
941
942resetenv [<name> ...]
943 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
944 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
945 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
946 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
947 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
948 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
949 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
950 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
951
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100952stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200953 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
954 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
955 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
956 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
957 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
958 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100959 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100960 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
961 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
962 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
963 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200964
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200965server-state-base <directory>
966 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200967 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
968 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200969
970server-state-file <file>
971 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
972 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
973 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
974 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
975 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
976 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
977 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
978 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200979 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
980 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200981
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100982setenv <name> <value>
983 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
984 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
985 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
986 and "unsetenv".
987
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100988ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
990 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300991 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100992 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
993 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
994 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
995 "bind" keyword for more information.
996
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100997ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
998 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
999 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1000 keyword to see available options.
1001
1002 Example:
1003 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001004 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001005
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001006ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1008 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001009 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001010 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
1011 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
1012 information.
1013
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001014ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1016 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1017 keyword to see available options.
1018
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001019ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1021 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1022 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001023 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001024 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001025 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1026 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1027 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1028 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001029 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1030 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1031 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1032
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001033ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1034 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1035 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1036 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1037
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001038stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1039 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1040 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1041 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001042 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001043 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001044
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001045 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1046 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1047 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001048
1049stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1050 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1051 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001052 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001053
1054stats maxconn <connections>
1055 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1056 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1057
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001058uid <number>
1059 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1060 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1061 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1062 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1063
1064ulimit-n <number>
1065 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1066 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1067 option.
1068
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001069unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1070 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1071
1072 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1073 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1074 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1075 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1076 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1077 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1078 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1079 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1080 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1081 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1082
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001083unsetenv [<name> ...]
1084 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1085 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1086 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1087 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1088 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1089 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1090 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1091
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001092user <user name>
1093 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1094 See also "uid" and "group".
1095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001096node <name>
1097 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1098
1099 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1100 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1101 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1102 traffic.
1103
1104description <text>
1105 Add a text that describes the instance.
1106
1107 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1108 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1109 "<" and ">" characters.
1110
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100111151degrees-data-file <file path>
1112 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001113 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001114
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001115 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001116 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1117
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000111851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001119 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1120 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1121 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1122
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001123 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001124 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1125
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200112651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001127 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1128 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1129
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001130 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
113351degrees-cache-size <number>
1134 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1135 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1136 By default, this cache is disabled.
1137
1138 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001139 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1140
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001141wurfl-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1146 with USE_WURFL=1.
1147
1148wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1149 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1150 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1151 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1152
1153 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1154
1155 Valid WURFL properties are:
1156 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1157
1158 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1159 device.
1160
1161 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1162 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1163
1164 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1165 particular web request.
1166
1167 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1168 used Libwurfl API version.
1169
1170 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1171 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1172 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1173
1174 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1175 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1176
1177 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1178 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1179
1180 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1181
1182 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1183
1184 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1185 with USE_WURFL=1.
1186
1187wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1188 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1189 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1190
1191 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1192 with USE_WURFL=1.
1193
1194wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1195 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1196 thus before the chroot.
1197
1198 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1199 with USE_WURFL=1.
1200
1201wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1202 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1203 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001204 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001206 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001207 mode is enabled by default.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1213 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1214 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1215 - "0" : no cache is used.
1216 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1217 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1218 the highest performing option.
1219
1220 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1221 with USE_WURFL=1.
1222
1223wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1224 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1225 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1226
1227 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1228 with USE_WURFL=1.
1229
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012313.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001232-----------------------
1233
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001234max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1235 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1236 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1237 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1238 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1239 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1240 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1241 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1242 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244maxconn <number>
1245 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1246 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1247 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001248 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1249 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1250 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1251 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001252 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1253 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1254 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1255 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1256 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001257
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001258maxconnrate <number>
1259 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1260 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1261 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1262 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1263 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1264 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1265 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1266 fairness.
1267
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001268maxcomprate <number>
1269 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001271 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1272 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1273 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001274 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001275 default value.
1276
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001277maxcompcpuusage <number>
1278 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1279 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1280 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1281 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1282 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1283 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1284 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1285 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1286
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001287maxpipes <number>
1288 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1289 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1290 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1291 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1292 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1293 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1294
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001295maxsessrate <number>
1296 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1297 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1298 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1299 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1300 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1301 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1302 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1303 fairness.
1304
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001305maxsslconn <number>
1306 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1307 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1308 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1309 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1310 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1311 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1312 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001313 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1314 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1315 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1316 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1317 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1318 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1319 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001320
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001321maxsslrate <number>
1322 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1323 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1324 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1325 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1326 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1327 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1328 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1329 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1330 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1331 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1332
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001333maxzlibmem <number>
1334 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1335 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1336 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001337 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1338 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1339 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1340
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001341noepoll
1342 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1343 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001344 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001345
1346nokqueue
1347 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1348 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1349 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1350
1351nopoll
1352 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1353 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001355 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001356
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001357nosplice
1358 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001359 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001360 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001361 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001362 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1363 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1364 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1365 "option splice-response".
1366
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001367nogetaddrinfo
1368 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1369 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1370
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001371noreuseport
1372 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1373 command line argument "-dR".
1374
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001375spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001376 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1377 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1378 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1379 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1380 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1381 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001383ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001384 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001385 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001386 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1387 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1388 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1389 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1390 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001391 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1392 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001393 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1394 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1395 openssl configuration file uses:
1396 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1397
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001398ssl-mode-async
1399 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001400 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001401 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1402 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1403 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1404 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1405 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001406
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001407tune.buffers.limit <number>
1408 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1409 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1410 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1411 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1412 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001413 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001414 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1415 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1416 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1417 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1418 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1419 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1420 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1421 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1422 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1423
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001424tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1425 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1426 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1427 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1428 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1429
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001430tune.bufsize <number>
1431 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1432 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1433 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1434 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1435 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1436 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1437 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001438 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1439 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1440 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001441 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1442 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001443
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001444tune.chksize <number>
1445 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1446 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1447 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1448 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1449 checks whenever possible.
1450
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001451tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1452 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1453 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1454 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1455 this value. The default value is 1.
1456
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001457tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1458 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1459 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1460 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1461 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1462 change it.
1463
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001464tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1465 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001466 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1467 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001468 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1469 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1470 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1471 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1472 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1473
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001474tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1475 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1476 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1477 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1478 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1479 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1480 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1481 recommended not to change this value.
1482
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001483tune.http.cookielen <number>
1484 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1485 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1486 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1487 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1488 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1489 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1490 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1491 to change this value.
1492
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001493tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001494 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1495 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001496 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001497 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001498 configuration directives too.
1499 The default value is 1024.
1500
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001501tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1502 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1503 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1504 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1505 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1506 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1507 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001508 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1509 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1510 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001511
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001512tune.idletimer <timeout>
1513 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1514 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1515 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1516 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1517 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1518 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001519 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001520 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1521 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1522
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001523tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1524 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001525 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001526 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1527 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001528 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001529 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1530 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1531
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001532tune.lua.maxmem
1533 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1534 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1535 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1536 memory.
1537
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001538tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1539 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001540 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1541 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001542 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001543
1544tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1545 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1546 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1547 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1548 check servers.
1549
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001550tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1551 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1552 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1553 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001554 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001555
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001556tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001557 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1558 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1559 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1560 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1561 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1562 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1563 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1564 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1565 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1566 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001567
1568tune.maxpollevents <number>
1569 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1570 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1571 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1572 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1573 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1574
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001575tune.maxrewrite <number>
1576 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1577 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1578 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1579 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1580 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1581 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1582 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1583 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1584 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1585 bufsize.
1586
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001587tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1588 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1589 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1590 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1591 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1592 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1593 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1594 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1595 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1596 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1597 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1598 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1599 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1600 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1601 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1602 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1603 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1604 setting this parameter to 0.
1605
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001606tune.pipesize <number>
1607 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1608 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1609 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1610 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1611 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1612 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1613
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001614tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1615tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1616 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1617 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1618 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1619 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001620 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001621 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1622 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1623
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001624tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001625 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001626 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1627 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1628 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1629 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1630
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001631tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1632 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1633 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1634 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1635
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001636tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1637tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1638 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1639 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1640 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1641 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001642 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001643 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1644 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1645 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1646 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1647 notifying haproxy again.
1648
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001649tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001650 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1651 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1652 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001653 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001654 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001655 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001656 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1657 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1658 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001659 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1660 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001661
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001662tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1663 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1664 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1665 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1666 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1667 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1668 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1669
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001670tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1671 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001672 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001673 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1674 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1675 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1676 being used for too long.
1677
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001678tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1679 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1680 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1681 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1682 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1683 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1684 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1685 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1686 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1687 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1688 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001689 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001690 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001691
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001692tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1693 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1694 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1695 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1696 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1697 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1698 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1699 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001700 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1701 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001702
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001703tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1704 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1705 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1706 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1707 1000 entries.
1708
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001709tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1710 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1711 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1712 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1713
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001714tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001715tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001716tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1717tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1718tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001719 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1720 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1721 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1722 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1723 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1724 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1725 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1726 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001727
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001728 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1729 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1730 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1731 all available space is consumed.
1732 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1733 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1734 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001735
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001736tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1737 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001738 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001739 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001741 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1742
1743tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1744 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1745 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001746 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1747 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017493.3. Debugging
1750--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001751
1752debug
1753 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1754 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1755 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1756 system startup.
1757
1758quiet
1759 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1760 line argument "-q".
1761
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017633.4. Userlists
1764--------------
1765It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1766http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1767it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1768
1769userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001770 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001771 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1772
1773group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001774 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001775 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1776 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1777
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001778user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1779 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001780 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1781 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001782 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1783 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1784 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1785 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001786
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001787 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1788 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1789 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1790 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1791 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1792 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1793 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1794 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1795 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001796
1797 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001798 userlist L1
1799 group G1 users tiger,scott
1800 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001801
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001802 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1803 user scott insecure-password elgato
1804 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001806 userlist L2
1807 group G1
1808 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001809
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001810 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1811 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1812 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001813
1814 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001816
18173.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001818----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001819It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1820several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1821instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1822values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1823automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1824In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1825using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1826tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1827reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1828Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1829that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1830each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001831
1832peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001833 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001834 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1835
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001836disabled
1837 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1838 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1839 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1840
1841enable
1842 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1843
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001844peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1845 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1846 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1847 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1848 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1849 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1850 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1851
1852 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1853 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1854
1855 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1856 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1857 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1858 across all peers.
1859
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001860 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1861 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001862
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001863 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001864 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001865 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1866 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1867 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001868
1869 backend mybackend
1870 mode tcp
1871 balance roundrobin
1872 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1873 stick on src
1874
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001875 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1876 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001877
1878
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018793.6. Mailers
1880------------
1881It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1882If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1883in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1884
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001885mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001886 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1887 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1888
1889mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1890 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 mailers mymailers
1894 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1895 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1896
1897 backend mybackend
1898 mode tcp
1899 balance roundrobin
1900
1901 email-alert mailers mymailers
1902 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1903 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1904
1905 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1906 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1907
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001908timeout mail <time>
1909 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1910 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1911 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1912 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1913
1914 Example:
1915 mailers mymailers
1916 timeout mail 20s
1917 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001920----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001921
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001922Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001923 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001924 - frontend <name>
1925 - backend <name>
1926 - listen <name>
1927
1928A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1929its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1930section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001932
1933A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1934connections.
1935
1936A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1937to forward incoming connections.
1938
1939A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1940parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1943'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1944case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1945
1946Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1947logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1948proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1949However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1950name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1951
1952Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1953and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001954bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001955protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1956modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1957arbitrary criteria.
1958
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001959In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1960a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1961the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1962
1963 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1964 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1965 between responses and new requests.
1966
1967 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1968 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1969 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1970 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1971
1972 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1973 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1974 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1975
1976 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1977 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1978 client-facing connection remains open.
1979
1980 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1981 after the end of the response.
1982
1983The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1984frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1985following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1986weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1987
1988 Backend mode
1989
1990 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1991 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1992 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1993 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1994 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1995 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1996 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1997 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1998 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1999 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
2000 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
2001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020044.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2005--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2008limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2009they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2010limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002011marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002012option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002013and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2014with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2015specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002018 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2019------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2020acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002021appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022backlog X X X -
2023balance X - X X
2024bind - X X -
2025bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002026block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002027capture cookie - X X -
2028capture request header - X X -
2029capture response header - X X -
2030clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002031compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002032contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2033cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002034declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002035default-server X - X X
2036default_backend X X X -
2037description - X X X
2038disabled X X X X
2039dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002040email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002041email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002042email-alert mailers X X X X
2043email-alert myhostname X X X X
2044email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002045enabled X X X X
2046errorfile X X X X
2047errorloc X X X X
2048errorloc302 X X X X
2049-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2050errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002051force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002052filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053fullconn X - X X
2054grace X X X X
2055hash-type X - X X
2056http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002057http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002058http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002059http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002060http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002061http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002062http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002063id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002064ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002065load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002066log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002067log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002068log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002069log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002070max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002071maxconn X X X -
2072mode X X X X
2073monitor fail - X X -
2074monitor-net X X X -
2075monitor-uri X X X -
2076option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2077option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2078option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2079option allbackups (*) X - X X
2080option checkcache (*) X - X X
2081option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2082option contstats (*) X X X -
2083option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2084option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2085option forceclose (*) X X X X
2086-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2087option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002088option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002089option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002090option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002091option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002092option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002093option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002094option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002095option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2096option httpchk X - X X
2097option httpclose (*) X X X X
2098option httplog X X X X
2099option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002100option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002101option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002102option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002103option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2104option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2105option logasap (*) X X X -
2106option mysql-check X - X X
2107option nolinger (*) X X X X
2108option originalto X X X X
2109option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002110option pgsql-check X - X X
2111option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002113option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002114option smtpchk X - X X
2115option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2116option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2117option splice-request (*) X X X X
2118option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002119option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002120option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2121option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2122-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002123option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002124option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2125option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2126option tcpka X X X X
2127option tcplog X X X X
2128option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002129external-check command X - X X
2130external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002131persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2132rate-limit sessions X X X -
2133redirect - X X X
2134redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2135redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2136reqadd - X X X
2137reqallow - X X X
2138reqdel - X X X
2139reqdeny - X X X
2140reqiallow - X X X
2141reqidel - X X X
2142reqideny - X X X
2143reqipass - X X X
2144reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002145reqitarpit - X X X
2146reqpass - X X X
2147reqrep - X X X
2148-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002149reqtarpit - X X X
2150retries X - X X
2151rspadd - X X X
2152rspdel - X X X
2153rspdeny - X X X
2154rspidel - X X X
2155rspideny - X X X
2156rspirep - X X X
2157rsprep - X X X
2158server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002159server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002160server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161source X - X X
2162srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002163stats admin - X X X
2164stats auth X X X X
2165stats enable X X X X
2166stats hide-version X X X X
2167stats http-request - X X X
2168stats realm X X X X
2169stats refresh X X X X
2170stats scope X X X X
2171stats show-desc X X X X
2172stats show-legends X X X X
2173stats show-node X X X X
2174stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002175-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2176stick match - - X X
2177stick on - - X X
2178stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002179stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002180stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002181tcp-check connect - - X X
2182tcp-check expect - - X X
2183tcp-check send - - X X
2184tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002185tcp-request connection - X X -
2186tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002187tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002188tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002189tcp-response content - - X X
2190tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002191timeout check X - X X
2192timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002193timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002194timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2195timeout connect X - X X
2196timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2197timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2198timeout http-request X X X X
2199timeout queue X - X X
2200timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002201timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2203timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002204timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002206unique-id-format X X X -
2207unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002208use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002209use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002210------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2211 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002212
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022144.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2215---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216
2217This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2218
2219
2220acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2221 Declare or complete an access list.
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 no | yes | yes | yes
2224 Example:
2225 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2226 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2227 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002229 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002230
2231
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002232appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2233 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 no | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2239 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2240
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002241 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 checked in each cookie value.
2243
2244 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2245 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2246 milliseconds.
2247
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002248 request-learn
2249 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2250 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2251 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2252 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2253 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2254 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2255
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002256 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2257 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2258 data following this prefix.
2259
2260 Example :
2261 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2262
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002263 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2264 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002265
2266 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2267 2 modes are currently supported :
2268 - path-parameters :
2269 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2270 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2271 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2272 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2273 - query-string :
2274 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2275 query string.
2276
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002277 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2278 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2279 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002280
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002281 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2282 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283
2284
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002285backlog <conns>
2286 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | yes | yes | no
2289 Arguments :
2290 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2291 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002292 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002293
2294 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2295 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2296 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2297 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2298 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2299 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2300 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2301 backlog parameter.
2302
2303 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2304 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2305 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2306
2307 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2308
2309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002311balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2314 yes | no | yes | yes
2315 Arguments :
2316 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2317 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2318 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2319 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2320
2321 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2322 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2323 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2324 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002325 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002326 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002327 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2328 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2329 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2330 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2331 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2332 it, so that you don't worry.
2333
2334 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2335 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2336 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2337 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2338 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2339 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2340 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2341 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002343 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2344 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2345 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2346 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2347 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2348 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2349 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2350 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2351
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002352 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002353 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002354 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2355 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002356 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002357 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2358 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2359 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2360 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2361 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002362 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2363 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2364 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2365 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2366 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2367 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2370 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2371 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2372 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2373 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2374 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2375 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2376 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002377 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002379 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2380 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2381 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002383 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2384 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2385 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2386 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2387 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2388 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2389 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2390 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2391 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2392 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2393 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2394 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002396 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002397 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2398 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2399 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2400 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2401 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2402 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2403 URIs start with a leading "/".
2404
2405 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2406 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2407 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2408 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002410 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002411 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2412
2413 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002414 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2415 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002416 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2417 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2418 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2419 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002420 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002421 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2422 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002423
2424 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2425 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2426 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2427 server will receive the request.
2428
2429 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2430 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2431 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2432 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2433 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002434 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2435 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2436 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002438 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2439 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2440 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2441 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2442 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002444 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002445 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2446 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2447 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2448
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002449 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2450 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2451 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2452
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002453 random A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
2454 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2455 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2456 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2457 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
2458 or removed. The hash-balance-factor directive can be used to
2459 further improve fairness of the load balancing, especially
2460 in situations where servers show highly variable response
2461 times.
2462
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002463 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002464 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002465 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2466 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2467 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2468 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2469 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2470 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002471 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002472 used instead.
2473
2474 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2475 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2476 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2477 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2478
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002479 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2480 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2481 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2482
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002483 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002486 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2487 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002488
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002489 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2490 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2491 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492
2493 Examples :
2494 balance roundrobin
2495 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002496 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002497 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2498 balance hdr(host)
2499 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002500
2501 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2502 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002504 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002505 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2506 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2507 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2508 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2509
2510 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2511 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2512 defaults to 16 kB.
2513
2514 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2515 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2516
2517 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2518 Round Robin.
2519
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002520 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002521 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2522 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2523 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2524
2525 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2526
2527 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002528 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002529 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2530 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2531 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002533 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
2535
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002536bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2537bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 no | yes | yes | no
2541 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002542 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2543 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2544 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2545 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002546 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002547 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2548 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2549 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2550 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2551 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2552 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2553 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002554 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2555 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2556 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2557 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2558 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2559 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2560 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002561 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2562 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2563 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002564 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2565 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2566 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2567 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002568 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2569 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2570 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002571
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002572 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2573 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002574 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2575 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2576 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002577 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2578 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2579 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2580 the range.
2581
2582 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2583 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2584 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2585 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2586 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2587 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2588 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002589 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002590 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002592 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002593 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002594 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2595 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2596 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2597 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2598 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2599 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002601 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2602 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2603 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2604 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2607 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2608 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2609 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2610 in a frontend.
2611
2612 Example :
2613 listen http_proxy
2614 bind :80,:443
2615 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002616 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002618 listen http_https_proxy
2619 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002620 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002621
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002622 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2623 bind ipv6@:80
2624 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2625 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2626
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002627 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002628 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002629
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002630 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2631 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2632 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2633 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2634 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2635
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002636 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002637 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
2639
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002640bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002641 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | yes | yes | yes
2644 Arguments :
2645 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2646 may be used to override a default value.
2647
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002648 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002649 option may be combined with other numbers.
2650
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002651 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002652 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2653 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2654 missing from all processes.
2655
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002656 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002657 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002658 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2659 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2660 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2661 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2662 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002663 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002664
2665 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2666 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2667 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2668 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2669 and 'even' instances.
2670
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002671 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2672 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2673 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2674 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002675
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002676 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2677 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2678
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002679 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2680 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2681 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2682
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002683 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2684 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2685
2686 Example :
2687 listen app_ip1
2688 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002689 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002690
2691 listen app_ip2
2692 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002693 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002694
2695 listen management
2696 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002697 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002698
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002699 listen management
2700 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2701 bind-process 1-4
2702
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002703 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002704
2705
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002706block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2709 no | yes | yes | yes
2710
2711 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2712 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002713 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002714 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002716 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2717 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2718 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002720 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2721 "http-request deny" instead.
2722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002723 Example:
2724 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2725 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2726 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002727 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2728 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2729 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002731 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2732 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2733 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
2735capture cookie <name> len <length>
2736 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2738 no | yes | yes | no
2739 Arguments :
2740 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2741 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2742 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2743 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002744 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
2746 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2747 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2748 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2749 right if it exceeds <length>.
2750
2751 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2752 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2753 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2754 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2755
2756 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2757 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2758 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2759
2760 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2761 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2762 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002763 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2764 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2765 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
2767 Example:
2768 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2769
2770 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002771 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772
2773
2774capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002775 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 no | yes | yes | no
2778 Arguments :
2779 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002780 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2782 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2783 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2784
2785 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2786 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2787 it exceeds <length>.
2788
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002789 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2791 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002792 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2793 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2794 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2795 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002796 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002797 environments to find where the request came from.
2798
2799 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2800 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2801 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2802 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002803
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002804 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2805 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2806 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2807 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2808 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809
2810 Example:
2811 capture request header Host len 15
2812 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002813 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002815 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 about logging.
2817
2818
2819capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002820 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2822 no | yes | yes | no
2823 Arguments :
2824 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002825 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2827 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2828 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2829
2830 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2831 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2832 it exceeds <length>.
2833
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002834 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2836 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2837 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002838 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2839 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2840 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2841 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002842
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002843 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2844 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2845 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2846 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2847 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
2849 Example:
2850 capture response header Content-length len 9
2851 capture response header Location len 15
2852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002853 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854 about logging.
2855
2856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002857clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2860 yes | yes | yes | no
2861 Arguments :
2862 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2864 as explained at the top of this document.
2865
2866 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2867 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2868 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2869 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2870 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2871 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2872 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2873 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002874 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002876 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
2878 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2879 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2880 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2881 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2882 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2883 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2884
2885 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2886 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2887
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002888 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2889 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002890
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002891compression algo <algorithm> ...
2892compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002893compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002894 Enable HTTP compression.
2895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2896 yes | yes | yes | yes
2897 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002898 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2899 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2900 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2901
2902 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002903 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2904 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2905 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002906
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002907 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002908 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002909
2910 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2911 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2912 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2913 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2914 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002915 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002916
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002917 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2918 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2919 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2920 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2921 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2922 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2923 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002924 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002925
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002926 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002927 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002928 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2929 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2930 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2931 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2932 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002933
2934 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2935 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2936 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2937 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2938 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002939 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2940 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2941 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2942 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2943 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002944 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2945 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002946
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002947 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002948 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2949 "Accept-Encoding" header
2950 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002951 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002952 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2953 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002954 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2955 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2956 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2957 "multipart"
2958 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2959 header
2960 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2961 and later
2962 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2963 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002964
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002965 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2966 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002967
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002968 Examples :
2969 compression algo gzip
2970 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002971
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002972
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002973contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2976 yes | no | yes | yes
2977 Arguments :
2978 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2979 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2980 as explained at the top of this document.
2981
2982 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002983 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002984 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002985 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2987 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2988 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2989
2990 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2991 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2992 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2993 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2994 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2995 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2996
2997 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2998 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2999 instead.
3000
3001 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3002 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3003
3004
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003005cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003006 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3007 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003008 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3011 yes | no | yes | yes
3012 Arguments :
3013 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3014 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3015 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3016 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3017 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3018 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003019 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003020 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3021 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3022
3023 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3024 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3025 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3026 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3027 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3028 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003029 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3030 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003031 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003032 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3033 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
3035 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003036 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003037
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003038 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003039 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3040 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003041 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003042 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3043 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3044 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3045 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3046 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3047 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3048 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
3050 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3051 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3052 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3053 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3054 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3055 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3056 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3057 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3058 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003059 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003060 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3061 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3062 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003064 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3065 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3066 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003067 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3068 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3069 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3070 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003071 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3072 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3073 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003074
3075 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3076 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3077 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3078 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3079 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3080 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3081 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3082 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3083 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3084
3085 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3086 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3087 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3088 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3089 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3090 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3091 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3092 persistence cookie in the cache.
3093 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3094
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003095 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3096 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3097 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3098 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3099 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003100 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003101 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3102 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3103 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3104 they logout.
3105
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003106 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3107 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3108 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3109 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3110
3111 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3112 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3113 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3114 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3115 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3116 this attribute.
3117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003118 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003119 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003120 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3121 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3122 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3123 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3124 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3125 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003126
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003127 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3128 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3129 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3130 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3131 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3132 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3133 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3134 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003135 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003136 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3137 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3138 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3139 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3140 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3141 the site.
3142
3143 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3144 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3145 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3146 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3147 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3148 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3149 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3150 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3151 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3152 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3153 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3154 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3155 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003156 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003157 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3158 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3159
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003160 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3161 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3162 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3163 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3164 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3165 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3168 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3169 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3170 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172 Examples :
3173 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3174 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3175 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003176 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003177
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003178 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003180
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003181declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3182 Declares a capture slot.
3183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 no | yes | yes | no
3185 Arguments:
3186 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3187
3188 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3189 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3190 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3191 for use in the response.
3192
3193 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003194 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003195 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3196
3197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003198default-server [param*]
3199 Change default options for a server in a backend
3200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3201 yes | no | yes | yes
3202 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003203 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3204 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3205 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3206 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003207
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003208 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003209 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3210
3211 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003214default_backend <backend>
3215 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 yes | yes | yes | no
3218 Arguments :
3219 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3220
3221 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3222 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3223 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3224 will catch all undetermined requests.
3225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003226 Example :
3227
3228 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3229 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3230 default_backend dynamic
3231
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003232 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003234
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003235description <string>
3236 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3238 no | yes | yes | yes
3239 Arguments : string
3240
3241 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3242 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3243 it describes.
3244 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3245
3246
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003247disabled
3248 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3250 yes | yes | yes | yes
3251 Arguments : none
3252
3253 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3254 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3255 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3256 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3257 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3258 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3259 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3260
3261 See also : "enabled"
3262
3263
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003264dispatch <address>:<port>
3265 Set a default server address
3266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003268 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003269
3270 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3271 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3272 during start-up.
3273
3274 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3275 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3276 possible with normal servers.
3277
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003278 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003279 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3280 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3281 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3282 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3283
3284 See also : "server"
3285
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003286
3287dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3288 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3290 yes | no | yes | yes
3291 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3292
3293 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003294 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003295 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3296 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003297 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003298 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300enabled
3301 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3303 yes | yes | yes | yes
3304 Arguments : none
3305
3306 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3307 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3308
3309 See also : "disabled"
3310
3311
3312errorfile <code> <file>
3313 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 yes | yes | yes | yes
3316 Arguments :
3317 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003318 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3319 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
3321 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003322 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003324 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3325 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003326
3327 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3328 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3329 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3330
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003331 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3334 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3335 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3336 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3337
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003338 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3339 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003340 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003341 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3342 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3343 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3346 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3347 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003348 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003349 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3350
3351 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3352
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003353 Example :
3354 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003355 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003356 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3357 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3358
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003359
3360errorloc <code> <url>
3361errorloc302 <code> <url>
3362 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | yes
3365 Arguments :
3366 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003367 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3368 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369
3370 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3371 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3372 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3373 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003374 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003375
3376 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3377 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3378 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3379
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003380 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3381
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003382 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3383 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3384 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3385 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003386 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003387 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3388 request.
3389
3390 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3391
3392
3393errorloc303 <code> <url>
3394 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3396 yes | yes | yes | yes
3397 Arguments :
3398 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003399 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3400 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003401
3402 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3403 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3404 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3405 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003406 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003407
3408 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3409 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3410 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3411
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003412 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3413
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003414 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3415 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3416 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3417 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003418 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419
3420 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3421
3422
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003423email-alert from <emailaddr>
3424 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003425 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 yes | yes | yes | yes
3428
3429 Arguments :
3430
3431 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3432
3433 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3434 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3435
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003436 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003437 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3438 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003439
3440
3441email-alert level <level>
3442 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3443 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3444 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3445 yes | yes | yes | yes
3446
3447 Arguments :
3448
3449 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3450 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3451 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3452
3453 By default level is alert
3454
3455 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3456 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3457 for the proxy.
3458
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003459 Alerts are sent when :
3460
3461 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3462 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3463 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3464 is notice or lower
3465 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3466 and a health check status update occurs
3467
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003468 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3469 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003470 section 3.6 about mailers.
3471
3472
3473email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3474 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | yes
3477
3478 Arguments :
3479
3480 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3481
3482 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3483 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3484
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003485 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3486 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003487
3488
3489email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3490 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3491 mailers.
3492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | yes | yes | yes
3494
3495 Arguments :
3496
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003497 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003498
3499 By default the systems hostname is used.
3500
3501 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3502 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3503 for the proxy.
3504
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003505 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3506 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003507
3508
3509email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003510 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003511 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3512 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | yes | yes | yes
3514
3515 Arguments :
3516
3517 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3518
3519 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3520 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3521
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003522 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003523 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3524
3525
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003526force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3527 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003529 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003530
3531 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3532 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3533 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3534 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3535 marked down for maintenance operations.
3536
3537 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3538 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3539 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3540 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3541 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3542 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3543 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3544 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3545 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3546
3547 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3548 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3549 is used.
3550
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003551 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003552 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003553
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003554
3555filter <name> [param*]
3556 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3558 no | yes | yes | yes
3559 Arguments :
3560 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3561 referenced in section 9.
3562
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003563 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003564 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003565 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3566 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003567
3568 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3569 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3570
3571 Example:
3572 listen
3573 bind *:80
3574
3575 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3576 filter compression
3577 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3578
3579 compression algo gzip
3580 compression offload
3581
3582 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3583
3584 See also : section 9.
3585
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587fullconn <conns>
3588 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 yes | no | yes | yes
3591 Arguments :
3592 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3593 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3594
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003595 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003596 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003597 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003598 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3599 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3600 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3601 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3602 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003603 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003604
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003605 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3606 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003607 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3608 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3609 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611 Example :
3612 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3613 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3614 # connections.
3615 backend dynamic
3616 fullconn 10000
3617 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3618 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3619
3620 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3621
3622
3623grace <time>
3624 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003627 Arguments :
3628 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3629 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3630 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3631
3632 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3633 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003634 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003635 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3636
3637 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3638 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3639 simplify it.
3640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003642hash-balance-factor <factor>
3643 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | no | no | yes
3646 Arguments :
3647 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3648 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3649 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3650
3651 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3652 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3653 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3654 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3655 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3656 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3657 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3658
3659 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3660 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3661 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3662 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3663 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3664
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003665 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3666 consistent hashing mechanism.
3667
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003668 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3669
3670
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003671hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003672 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3674 yes | no | yes | yes
3675 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003676 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3677 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003678
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003679 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3680 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3681 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3682 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3683 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3684 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3685 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3686 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3687 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3688 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003689
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003690 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3691 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3692 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3693 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3694 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3695 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3696 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3697 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3698 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3699 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3700 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3701 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3702 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003703 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3704 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003705
3706 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3707
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003708 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003709 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3710 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3711 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003712 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3713 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3714 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003715
3716 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3717 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003718 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3719 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3720 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3721 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3722
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003723 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3724 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3725 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3726 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3727 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3728 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3729 parameter.
3730
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003731 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3732 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3733 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3734 used on strings.
3735
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003736 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3737
3738 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3739 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3740 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3741 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3742 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3743 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3744 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3745 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3746 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3747 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3748 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3749 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003750
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003751 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3752 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3753 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003754
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003755 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003756
3757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003758http-check disable-on-404
3759 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762 Arguments : none
3763
3764 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3765 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3766 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3767 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3768 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3769 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3770 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3771 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003772 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3773 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3774 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3775
3776 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3777
3778
3779http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003780 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003782 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003783 Arguments :
3784 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3785 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003786 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003787 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3788 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3789 details on the supported keywords.
3790
3791 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3792 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3793 with the usual backslash ('\').
3794
3795 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3796 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3797 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3798 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3799 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3800
3801 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003802 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003803 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3804 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3805 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3806
3807 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003808 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003809 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3810 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3811 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3812 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3813
3814 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003815 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003816 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3817 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3818 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3819 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3820 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003821 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003822 trace).
3823
3824 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003826 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3827 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3828 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3829 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3830 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003831 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003832
3833 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3834 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3835 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3836 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3837 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3838 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3839 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3840 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3841
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003842 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3843 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3844 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3845
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003846 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3847 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3848
3849 Examples :
3850 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003851 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003852
3853 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003854 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003855
3856 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003857 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003858
3859 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003860 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003862 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003863
3864
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003865http-check send-state
3866 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3868 yes | no | yes | yes
3869 Arguments : none
3870
3871 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3872 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3873 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3874 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3875 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3876
3877 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3878 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3879 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3880 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3881 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003882 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3883 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3884 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3885
3886 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3887 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3888 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3889
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003890 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3891 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3892 checked in multiple backends.
3893
3894 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3895 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3896
3897 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3898 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3899 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3900 one fails.
3901
3902 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3903 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3904 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3905
3906 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3907 server's queue.
3908
3909 Example of a header received by the application server :
3910 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3911 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3912
3913 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3914
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003915http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003916 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003917 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003918 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003919 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003920 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3921 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003922 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3923 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04003924 set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003925 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3926 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3927 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003928 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003929 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003930 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003931 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003932 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01003933 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003934 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003935 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003936 send-spoe-group |
3937 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003938 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003939 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003940 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3941
3942 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 no | yes | yes | yes
3944
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003945 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3946 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3947 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3948 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3949 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003950
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003951 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3952 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3953 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3954
3955 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003956 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3957 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3958 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3959 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003960
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003961 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3962 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3963 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3964 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3965
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003966 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3967 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3968 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003969 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3970 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003971 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3972 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3973 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3974 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3975 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003976 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003977 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3978 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003979
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003980 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3981 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3982 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3983 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3984 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3985
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003986 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3987 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3988 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003989 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3990 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003991
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003992 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3993 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3994 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003995 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003996 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3997 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3998 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3999 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4000
4001 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4002 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4003 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01004004 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
4005 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004006
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004007 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4008 <name>.
4009
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004010 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4011 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4012 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4013 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4014 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4015 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4016 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4017 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
4018
4019 Example:
4020
4021 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4022
4023 applied to:
4024
4025 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4026
4027 outputs:
4028
4029 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4030
4031 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4032
4033 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4034 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4035 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4036 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4037 header.
4038
4039 Example:
4040
4041 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4042
4043 applied to:
4044
4045 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4046
4047 outputs:
4048
4049 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4050
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004051 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4052 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4053 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4054 it.
4055
4056 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4057 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4058 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4059 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4060 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4061 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4062
4063 Example :
4064 # prepend the host name before the path
4065 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4066
4067 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4068 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4069 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4070 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4071 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4072 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4073 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4074 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4075
4076 Example :
4077 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4078 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4079
4080 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4081 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4082 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4083 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4084 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4085 "set-query".
4086
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004087 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4088 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4089 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4090 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4091 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4092 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4093 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4094 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4095
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004096 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4097 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4098 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4099 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4100 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4101 another equipment.
4102
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004103 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4104 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4105 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4106 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4107 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004108 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004109 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4110 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4111
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004112 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4113 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4114 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4115 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4116 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4117 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4118 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4119 admin privileges.
4120
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004121 - "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
4122 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to
4123 an integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
4124 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued
4125 requests are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
4126
4127 - "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
4128 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which
4129 converts to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this
4130 range will be truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by
4131 the priority class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given
4132 offset in milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
4133 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4134 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where
4135 the adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as
4136 highest priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value,
4137 where when combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
4138
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004139 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4140 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4141 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4142 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4143 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4144 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4145 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4146 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4147
4148 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4149 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4150 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4151 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4152 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4153 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4154
4155 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4156 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4157 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4158 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4159 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4160 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4161
4162 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4163 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4164 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4165 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4166 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4167 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4168 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4169 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4170 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4171
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004172 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004173 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4174 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4175 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4176 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4177 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4178 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4179 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4180 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4181 request header" for more information.
4182
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004183 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4184 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4185 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4186 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004187 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4188 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004189
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004190 - cache-use <name> :
4191 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4192
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004193 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4194 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02004195 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of
4196 counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set
4197 in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults
4198 to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The
4199 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004200 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4201 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4202 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4203 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4204 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4205 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4206 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4207
4208 These actions take one or two arguments :
4209 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4210 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004211 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004212 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4213
4214 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4215 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4216 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4217 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4218
4219 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4220 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4221 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4222 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4223 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4224 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4225 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4226 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4227
4228 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4229 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4230 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4231 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4232 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4233
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004234 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4235 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4236 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4237 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4238 continues.
4239
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004240 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4241 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4242 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4243 the actions evaluation continues.
4244
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004245 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4246 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4247
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004248 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4249 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4250 inline.
4251
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004252 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4253 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004254 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004255 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4256 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004257 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004258 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004259 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004260 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4261 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004262 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004263 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004264 and '_'.
4265
4266 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4267 followed by some converters.
4268
4269 Example:
4270
4271 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4272
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004273 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4274 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4275
4276 Example:
4277
4278 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4279
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004280 - set-src <expr> :
4281 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4282 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4283 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4284 source IP for privacy.
4285
4286 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4287 followed by some converters.
4288
4289 Example:
4290
4291 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4292 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4293
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004294 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4295 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004296
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004297 - set-src-port <expr> :
4298 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4299 expression.
4300
4301 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4302 followed by some converters.
4303
4304 Example:
4305
4306 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4307 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4308
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004309 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4310 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4311 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004312
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004313 - set-dst <expr> :
4314 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4315 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4316 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4317 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4318 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4319
4320 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4321 followed by some converters.
4322
4323 Example:
4324
4325 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4326 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4327
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004328 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4329 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4330
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004331 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4332 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4333 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4334 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4335
4336 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4337 followed by some converters.
4338
4339 Example:
4340
4341 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4342 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4343
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004344 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4345 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4346 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4347
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004348 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004349 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004350 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4351 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4352 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4353 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4354 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004355 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4356 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004357 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4358 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4359 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4360 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4361 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4362 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4363 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4364
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004365
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004366 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4367 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4368 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4369
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004370 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4371 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4372 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4373 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4374 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4375 SPOE agent name must be used.
4376
4377 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4378
4379 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4380 configuration.
4381
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004382 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4383
4384 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4385 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004386 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4387 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4388
4389 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4390 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4391 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4392 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004393
4394 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004395 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4396 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4397 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004398
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004399 http-request allow if nagios
4400 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4401 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4402 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004403
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004404 Example:
4405 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004406 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004407
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004408 Example:
4409 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4410 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004411 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004412 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4413 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4414 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4415 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4416 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4417 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4418
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004419 Example:
4420 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4421 acl add path /addacl
4422 acl del path /delacl
4423
4424 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4425
4426 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4427 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4428
4429 Example:
4430 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4431 acl setmap path /setmap
4432 acl delmap path /delmap
4433
4434 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4435
4436 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4437 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4438
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004439 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4440 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004441
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004442http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004443 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004444 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004445 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4446 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004447 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004448 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4449 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4450 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4451 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004452 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004453 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004454 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004455 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004456 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004457 sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004458 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004459 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004460 send-spoe-group |
4461 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004462 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004464 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4465
4466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 no | yes | yes | yes
4468
4469 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4470 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4471 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4472 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4473 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4474 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4475
4476 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4477 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4478 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4479 current section.
4480
4481 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4482 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4483 rules are evaluated.
4484
4485 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4486 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4487 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4488 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4489 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4490 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4491 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4492
4493 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4494 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4495 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4496 external users.
4497
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004498 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4499 <name>.
4500
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004501 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4502 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4503 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4504 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4505 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4506 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4507 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4508 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4509
4510 Example:
4511
4512 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4513
4514 applied to:
4515
4516 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4517
4518 outputs:
4519
4520 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4521
4522 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4523
4524 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4525 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4526 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4527 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4528 header.
4529
4530 Example:
4531
4532 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4533
4534 applied to:
4535
4536 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4537
4538 outputs:
4539
4540 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4541
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004542 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004543 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4544 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4545 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004546
4547 Example:
4548
4549 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4550 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004551 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4552 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004553
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004554 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4555 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4556 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4557 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4558 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4559 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4560 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4561 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4562
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004563 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4564 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4565 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4566 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4567 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4568 another equipment.
4569
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004570 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4571 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4572 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4573 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4574 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004575 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004576 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4577 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4578
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004579 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4580 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4581 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4582 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4583 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4584 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4585 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4586 admin privileges.
4587
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004588 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4589 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4590 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4591 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4592 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4593 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4594 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4595 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4596
4597 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4598 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4599 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4600 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4601 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4602 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4603
4604 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4605 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4606 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4607 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4608 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4609 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4610
4611 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4612 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4613 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4614 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4615 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4616 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4617 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4618 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4619 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4620
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004621 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4622 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4623 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4624 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4625 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4626 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4627 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4628 response header" for more information.
4629
4630 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4631 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4632 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4633 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4634 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004635 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4636 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004637
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004638 - cache-store <name> :
4639 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4640
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004641 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4642 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4643 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4644 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4645 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4646 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4647
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004648 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4649 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4650 inline.
4651
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004652 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4653 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004654 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004655 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4656 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004657 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004659 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004660 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4661 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004662 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004663 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4664 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004665
4666 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4667 followed by some converters.
4668
4669 Example:
4670
4671 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4672
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004673 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4674 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4675
4676 Example:
4677
4678 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4679
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004680 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4681 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4682 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4683 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004684 use of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4685 Layer 6 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004686 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4687
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004688 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4689 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4690 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4691 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4692 continues.
4693
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004694 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4695 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4696 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4697 the actions evaluation continues.
4698
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004699 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
4700 Same as "sc-inc-gpc0" action above but for GPC1 counter.
4701
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004702 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004703 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004704 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4705 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4706 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4707 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4708 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004709 down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact of using
4710 this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the client and
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004711 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4712 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4713 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4714 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4715 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4716 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4717 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4718
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004719 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4720 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4721 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4722 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4723 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4724 SPOE agent name must be used.
4725
4726 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4727
4728 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4729 configuration.
4730
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004731 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4732
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004733 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004734 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004735 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4736 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004737
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004738 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4739 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4740 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4741 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4742
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004743 Example:
4744 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4745
4746 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4747
4748 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4749 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4750
4751 Example:
4752 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4753
4754 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4755
4756 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4757 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4758
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004759 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4760 ACL usage.
4761
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004762
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004763http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4764 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4765
4766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4767 yes | no | yes | yes
4768
4769 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4770 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4771 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4772 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4773 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004774 This directive allows to tune this behavior.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004775
4776 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4777
4778 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4779 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4780 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4781 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4782 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4783 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4784 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4785 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4786 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4787 not checking any request past the first one.
4788
4789 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4790 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4791 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4792 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4793 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4794 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4795 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4796
4797 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4798 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4799 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4800 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4801 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4802 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4803 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4804 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4805 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4806 downsides of rare connection failures.
4807
4808 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4809 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4810 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4811 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4812 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4813 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004814 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004815 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4816 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4817 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4818 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4819 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4820
4821 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004822 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
4823 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
4824 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004825
4826 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004827 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004828
4829 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4830 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4831 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004832 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004833
4834 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4835 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4836 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4837
4838 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4839 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4840 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4841
4842 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4843
4844
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004845http-send-name-header [<header>]
4846 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4847
4848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850
4851 Arguments :
4852
4853 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4854
4855 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004856 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004857 is added with the header string proved.
4858
4859 See also : "server"
4860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004861id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004862 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 no | yes | yes | yes
4865 Arguments : none
4866
4867 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4868 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4869 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004870
4871
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004872ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4873 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004875 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004876
4877 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4878 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4879 and running).
4880
4881 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4882 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4883 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004884 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004885 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4886
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004887 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4888 "unless" condition is met.
4889
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004890 Example:
4891 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4892 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4893 ignore-persist if url_static
4894
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004895 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4896
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004897load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4898 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4900 yes | no | yes | yes
4901
4902 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4903 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4904 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004905 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004906 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4907 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4908 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4909 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4910
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004911 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004912 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004913 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004914
4915 Arguments:
4916 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4917 named "server-state-file".
4918
4919 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4920 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4921 name is used as a file name.
4922
4923 none don't load any stat for this backend
4924
4925 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004926 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4927 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4928 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004929 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004930 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004931
4932 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4933 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4934
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004935 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004936
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004937 global
4938 stats socket /tmp/socket
4939 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004940
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004941 defaults
4942 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004943
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004944 backend bk
4945 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4946 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004947
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004948
4949 Then one can run :
4950
4951 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4952
4953 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4954
4955 1
4956 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4957 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4958 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4959
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004960 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004961
4962 global
4963 stats socket /tmp/socket
4964 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4965
4966 defaults
4967 load-server-state-from-file local
4968
4969 backend bk
4970 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4971 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4972
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004973
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004974 Then one can run :
4975
4976 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4977
4978 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4979
4980 1
4981 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4982 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4983 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4984
4985 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4986 "show servers state"
4987
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004989log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004990log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004991no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004992 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004995
4996 Prefix :
4997 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4998 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4999 prefix does not allow arguments.
5000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005001 Arguments :
5002 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5003 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5004 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5005 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5006 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5007 parameter.
5008
5009 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5010 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5011
5012 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5013 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5014 standard syslog port).
5015
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005016 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5017 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5018 standard syslog port).
5019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005020 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5021 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5022 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005023 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005024
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005025 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5026 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005027
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005028 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5029 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5030 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5031 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5032 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5033 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5034 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5035 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5036 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5037 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005038 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005039
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005040 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5041
5042 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5043 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5044 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5045
5046 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5047 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5048 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005049 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5050 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5051 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5052 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5053 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005054
5055 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5056
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005057 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5058 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5059 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005060
5061 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5062 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5063 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5064 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5065
5066 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5067 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068
5069 Example :
5070 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005071 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5072 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005073 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005074
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005075
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005076log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005077 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5079 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005080
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005081 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5082 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5083 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5084 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5085 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005086
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005087 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5088 "option httplog" directives.
5089
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005090log-format-sd <string>
5091 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5093 yes | yes | yes | no
5094
5095 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5096 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5097 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5098 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5099 which covers the log format string in depth.
5100
5101 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5102 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5103
5104 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5105 log format to "rfc5424".
5106
5107 Example :
5108 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5109
5110
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005111log-tag <string>
5112 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | yes | yes | yes
5115
5116 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5117 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5118 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5119 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5120 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5121 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5122 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5123 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5124 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005125
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005126max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5127 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5128 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
5130
5131 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5132 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5133 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5134 servers.
5135
5136 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5137 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5138 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5139 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5140 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005141 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005142 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5143 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5144 picking a different server.
5145
5146 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5147 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5148 even if they have to be queued.
5149
5150 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5151 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5152
5153
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005154maxconn <conns>
5155 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5157 yes | yes | yes | no
5158 Arguments :
5159 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5160 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5161 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5162 closes.
5163
5164 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5165 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5166 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5167 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005168 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5169 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5170 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5171 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005172
5173 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5174 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5175 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5176
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005177 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5178
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005179 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5180
5181
5182mode { tcp|http|health }
5183 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | yes | yes | yes
5186 Arguments :
5187 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5188 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5189 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5190 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5191
5192 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5193 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5194 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5195 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5196 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5197
5198 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005199 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5200 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5201 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5202 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5203 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5204 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5205 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005207 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5208 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5209 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005211 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005212 defaults http_instances
5213 mode http
5214
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005215 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005216
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005218monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005219 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005222 Arguments :
5223 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5224 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005225 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005226 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5227 backend and its backup.
5228
5229 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5230 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5231 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5232 servers in a list of backends.
5233
5234 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5235 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5236 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5237 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5238 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5239 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5240 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005241 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5242 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005243
5244 Example:
5245 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005246 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005247 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5248 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5249 monitor-uri /site_alive
5250 monitor fail if site_dead
5251
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005252 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005253
5254
5255monitor-net <source>
5256 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5258 yes | yes | yes | no
5259 Arguments :
5260 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5261 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5262 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5263 followed by a mask.
5264
5265 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5266 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005267 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005268 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5269
5270 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5271 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5272 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5273 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005274 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5275 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5276 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005277
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005278 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5279 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5280 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5281 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5282 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5283 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005284
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005285 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5286 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005287
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005288 Example :
5289 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5290 frontend www
5291 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5292
5293 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5294
5295
5296monitor-uri <uri>
5297 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | yes | yes | no
5300 Arguments :
5301 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5302 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5303
5304 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5305 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5306 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5307 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5308 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5309 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5310 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5311 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5312
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005313 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5314 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5315 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5316 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5317 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5318 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5319 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5320 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005321
5322 Example :
5323 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5324 frontend www
5325 mode http
5326 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5327
5328 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005330
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331option abortonclose
5332no option abortonclose
5333 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336 Arguments : none
5337
5338 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5339 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5340 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5341 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005342 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005343 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5344 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5345 encountered while delivering the response.
5346
5347 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5348 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5349 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5350 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5351 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5352 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005353 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005354 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005355 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005356 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5357 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5358 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005360 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5361 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005362 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5363 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5364 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5365 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5366 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5367 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005368 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005369
5370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5372
5373 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5374
5375
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005376option accept-invalid-http-request
5377no option accept-invalid-http-request
5378 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5380 yes | yes | yes | no
5381 Arguments : none
5382
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005383 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005384 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005385 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005386 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5387 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5388 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5389 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5390 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005391 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5392 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5393 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5394 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005395 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005396 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005397 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5398 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5399 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005400
5401 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5402 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5403 been confirmed.
5404
5405 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5406 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005407 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5408 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005409 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5410
5411 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5412 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5413
5414 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5415 stats socket.
5416
5417
5418option accept-invalid-http-response
5419no option accept-invalid-http-response
5420 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5422 yes | no | yes | yes
5423 Arguments : none
5424
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005425 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005426 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005427 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005428 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5429 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5430 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5431 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5432 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005433 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5434 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5435 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005436
5437 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5438 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5439 been confirmed.
5440
5441 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5442 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5443 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5444 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5445
5446 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5447 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5448
5449 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5450 stats socket.
5451
5452
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005453option allbackups
5454no option allbackups
5455 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 yes | no | yes | yes
5458 Arguments : none
5459
5460 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5461 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5462 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5463 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5464 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5465 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5466 order between the backup servers anymore.
5467
5468 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5469 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5470
5471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5473
5474
5475option checkcache
5476no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005477 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5479 yes | no | yes | yes
5480 Arguments : none
5481
5482 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5483 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005484 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005485 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5486 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005487 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005488
5489 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005490 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005491 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005492 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5493 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005494 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005495 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005496 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5497 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005498 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005499 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5500 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005501 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005502 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5503 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5504 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5505 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5506 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5507 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5508 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5509 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5510 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5511
5512 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005513 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005514 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005515 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005516 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5517
5518 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5519 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005520 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005521 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005522
5523 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5524 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5525
5526
5527option clitcpka
5528no option clitcpka
5529 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | no
5532 Arguments : none
5533
5534 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5535 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005536 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005537 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5538
5539 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5540 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5541 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5542 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5543
5544 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5545 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5546 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5547 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5548 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5549
5550 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5551
5552 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5553 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5554 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5555
5556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5558
5559 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5560
5561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005562option contstats
5563 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | yes | yes | no
5566 Arguments : none
5567
5568 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5569 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5570 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5571 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005572 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5573 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5574 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5575 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5576 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005577
5578
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005579option dontlog-normal
5580no option dontlog-normal
5581 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 yes | yes | yes | no
5584 Arguments : none
5585
5586 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5587 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5588 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5589 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5590 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5591 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5592 logged.
5593
5594 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5595 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5596 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005598 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005599 logging.
5600
5601
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005602option dontlognull
5603no option dontlognull
5604 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | yes | yes | no
5607 Arguments : none
5608
5609 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5610 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5611 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5612 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5613 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5614 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005615 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5616 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5617 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005618
5619 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005620 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005621 would not be logged.
5622
5623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5625
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005626 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5627 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005628
5629
5630option forceclose
5631no option forceclose
5632 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005634 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005635 Arguments : none
5636
5637 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5638 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5639 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5640 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5641 global session times in the logs.
5642
5643 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005644 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005645 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005646
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005647 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5648 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5649 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5650
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005651 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5652 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5656
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005657 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005658
5659
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005660option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005661 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 yes | yes | yes | yes
5664 Arguments :
5665 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5666 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005667 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005668 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005669
5670 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5671 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5672 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5673 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5674 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5675 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5676 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005677 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5678 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5679 possible that the client has already brought one.
5680
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005681 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005682 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005683 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005684 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005685 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005686 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005687
5688 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5689 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5690 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5691 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5692 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5693 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5694 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5695
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005696 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5697 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5698 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5699 are under the control of the end-user.
5700
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005701 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005702 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5703 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005704 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5705 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5706 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005707
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005708 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005709 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5710 frontend www
5711 mode http
5712 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5713
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005714 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5715 backend www
5716 mode http
5717 option forwardfor header X-Client
5718
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005719 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005720 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005721
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005722
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005723option http-buffer-request
5724no option http-buffer-request
5725 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5727 yes | yes | yes | yes
5728 Arguments : none
5729
5730 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5731 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5732 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5733 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5734 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5735 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5736 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5737 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005738 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005739 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5740 default.
5741
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005742 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005743
5744
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005745option http-ignore-probes
5746no option http-ignore-probes
5747 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5749 yes | yes | yes | no
5750 Arguments : none
5751
5752 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5753 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5754 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5755 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5756 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5757 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5758 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5759 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5760 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005761 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5762 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005763 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5764
5765 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5766 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5767 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5768 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5769 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5770 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5771 are often the only way to detect them.
5772
5773 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5774 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5775
5776 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5777
5778
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005779option http-keep-alive
5780no option http-keep-alive
5781 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | yes | yes | yes
5784 Arguments : none
5785
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005786 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5787 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5788 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5789 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5790 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5791 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5792 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5793
5794 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5795 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005796 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5797 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5798 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5799 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5800 situations where this option may be useful :
5801
5802 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005803 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005804
5805 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5806 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5807
5808 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5809 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5810 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5811 request.
5812
5813 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5814 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005815 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5816 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5817 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005818
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005819 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5820 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5821 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5822 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5823 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5824 not set.
5825
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005826 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5827 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005828 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005829 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005830
5831 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005832 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5833 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005834
5835
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005836option http-no-delay
5837no option http-no-delay
5838 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | yes | yes | yes
5841 Arguments : none
5842
5843 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5844 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5845 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5846 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5847 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5848 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5849 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5850 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5851 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5852 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5853 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5854 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5855 affected.
5856
5857 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5858 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5859 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5860 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5861 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5862 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5863 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5864 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5865 latency environments.
5866
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005867 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5868
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005869
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005870option http-pretend-keepalive
5871no option http-pretend-keepalive
5872 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | yes | yes | yes
5875 Arguments : none
5876
5877 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5878 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5879 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5880 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5881 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5882 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5883 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5884 consider the response complete.
5885
5886 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5887 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5888 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5889 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5890 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5891 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5892
5893 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5894 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5895 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5896 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5897 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5898 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5899 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5900
5901 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5902 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005903 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005904 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5905 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005906
5907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5909
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005910 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5911 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005912
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005913
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005914option http-server-close
5915no option http-server-close
5916 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | yes
5919 Arguments : none
5920
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005921 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5922 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5923 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5924 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5925 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5926 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5927 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005928 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005929 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5930 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5931 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005932 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005933 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5934 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5935 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5936 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005937
5938 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5939 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5940 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5941 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005942 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5943 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005944
5945 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5946 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005947 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5948 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005949 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5950 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005951
5952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5954
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005955 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005956 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5957 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005958
5959
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005960option http-tunnel
5961no option http-tunnel
5962 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 yes | yes | yes | yes
5965 Arguments : none
5966
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005967 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5968 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5969 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5970 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5971 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5972 "option http-tunnel".
5973
5974 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005975 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005976 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5977 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5978 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5979 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5980 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5981 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5982 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005983
5984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5986
5987 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5988 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5989 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5990
5991
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005992option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005993no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005994 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | yes | yes | no
5997 Arguments : none
5998
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005999 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006000 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6001 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6002 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6003 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6004 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6005 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6006
6007 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6008 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006009 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6010 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6011 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006012
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006013 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6014 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6015 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6016 front of an existing proxy.
6017
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006018 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6019
6020 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
6021 http-server-close".
6022
6023
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006024option httpchk
6025option httpchk <uri>
6026option httpchk <method> <uri>
6027option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6028 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6030 yes | no | yes | yes
6031 Arguments :
6032 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6033 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6034 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6035 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6036 ones.
6037
6038 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6039 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6040 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6041
6042 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6043 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6044 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6045 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6046 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6047
6048 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6049 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6050 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6051 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6052 the lack of any response.
6053
6054 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6055
6056 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6057 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6058 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6059
6060 Examples :
6061 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6062 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6063 backend https_relay
6064 mode tcp
6065 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6066 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6067
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006068 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6069 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6070 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006071
6072
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006073option httpclose
6074no option httpclose
6075 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | yes | yes | yes
6078 Arguments : none
6079
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006080 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6081 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6082 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6083 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006084 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006085 "option http-tunnel".
6086
6087 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6088 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6089 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6090 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6091 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6092 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6093 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6094 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006095
6096 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006097 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006098 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6099 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6100 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6101 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6102 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006103
6104 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6105 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006106 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6107 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006108 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6109 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006110
6111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6113
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006114 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6115 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006116
6117
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006118option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006119 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006121 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006122 Arguments :
6123 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6124 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6125 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006126 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006127 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006128
6129 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6130 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6131 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6132 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6133 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6134 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6135 ports.
6136
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006137 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6138 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006139
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006140 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006142 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006143
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006144
6145option http_proxy
6146no option http_proxy
6147 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 yes | yes | yes | yes
6150 Arguments : none
6151
6152 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6153 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6154 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6155 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6156 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6157
6158 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6159 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006160 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6161 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006162
6163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6165
6166 Example :
6167 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6168 backend direct_forward
6169 option httpclose
6170 option http_proxy
6171
6172 See also : "option httpclose"
6173
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006174
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006175option independent-streams
6176no option independent-streams
6177 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 yes | yes | yes | yes
6180 Arguments : none
6181
6182 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6183 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6184 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6185 receive data or not.
6186
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006187 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006188 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6189 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6190 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6191 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6192 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6193 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6194 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6195 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6196 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6197 socket buffers.
6198
6199 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6200 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6201 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6202 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6203 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6204
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006205 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006206 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6207 deprecated.
6208
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006209 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006210
6211
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006212option ldap-check
6213 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 yes | no | yes | yes
6216 Arguments : none
6217
6218 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6219 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6220 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6221 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6222
6223 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6224 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6225
6226 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6227 configure it.
6228
6229 Example :
6230 option ldap-check
6231
6232 See also : "option httpchk"
6233
6234
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006235option external-check
6236 Use external processes for server health checks
6237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6238 yes | no | yes | yes
6239
6240 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6241 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6242 command".
6243
6244 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6245
6246 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6247
6248
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006249option log-health-checks
6250no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006251 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | no | yes | yes
6254 Arguments : none
6255
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006256 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6257 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6258 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006259
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006260 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6261 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6262 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6263 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6264 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006266 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006267 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006268
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006269 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6270 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6271 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006272
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006273
6274option log-separate-errors
6275no option log-separate-errors
6276 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6278 yes | yes | yes | no
6279 Arguments : none
6280
6281 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6282 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6283 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6284 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6285 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6286 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6287 provides very important information.
6288
6289 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6290 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6291 error logs.
6292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006293 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006294 logging.
6295
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006296
6297option logasap
6298no option logasap
6299 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 yes | yes | yes | no
6302 Arguments : none
6303
6304 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6305 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6306 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6307 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6308 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6309 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6310 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006311 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006312 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6313 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6314
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006315 Examples :
6316 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6317 mode http
6318 option httplog
6319 option logasap
6320 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6321
6322 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6323 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6324 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6325 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006327 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006328 logging.
6329
6330
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006331option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006332 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006335 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006336 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6337 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006338 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006339
6340 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6341 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006342 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006343 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6344 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6345 in the MySQL table, like this :
6346
6347 USE mysql;
6348 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6349 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6350
6351 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006352 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006353 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6354 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6355 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6356 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6357 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6358 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6359 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6360
6361 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6362 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006363
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006364 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006365
6366 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6367 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6368 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6369 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006370 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6371 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006372
6373 See also: "option httpchk"
6374
6375
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006376option nolinger
6377no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006378 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006381 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006383 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006384 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6385 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6386 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6387 connections.
6388
6389 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6390 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6391 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6392 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6393 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6394 this too.
6395
6396 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6397 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6398 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6399
6400 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6401 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6402 for servers.
6403
6404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6406
6407
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006408option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6409 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6411 yes | yes | yes | yes
6412 Arguments :
6413 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6414 matching <network>
6415 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6416 header name.
6417
6418 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6419 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6420 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6421 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6422 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6423 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6424 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6425 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6426 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6427 possible that the client has already brought one.
6428
6429 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6430 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6431 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6432 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6433 header and requires different one.
6434
6435 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6436 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6437 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6438 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6439 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6440 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6441 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6442
6443 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6444 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6445 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6446 both are defined.
6447
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006448 Examples :
6449 # Original Destination address
6450 frontend www
6451 mode http
6452 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6453
6454 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6455 backend www
6456 mode http
6457 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6458
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006459 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6460 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006461
6462
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006463option persist
6464no option persist
6465 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6467 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006468 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006469
6470 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6471 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6472 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6473 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6474 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6475 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6476 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6477 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6478 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6479 redirected to another valid server.
6480
6481 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6482 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6483
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006484 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006485
6486
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006487option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6488 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6490 yes | no | yes | yes
6491 Arguments :
6492 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6493 PostgreSQL server.
6494
6495 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6496 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6497 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6498 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6499
6500 See also: "option httpchk"
6501
6502
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006503option prefer-last-server
6504no option prefer-last-server
6505 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
6508 Arguments : none
6509
6510 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6511 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6512 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6513 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6514 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6515 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6516 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6517 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6518 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006519 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6520 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6521 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6522 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6523 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6524 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6525 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006526
6527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6529
6530 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6531
6532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006533option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006534option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006535no option redispatch
6536 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6538 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006539 Arguments :
6540 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6541 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6542 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006543 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006544 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006545 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006546 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6547 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6548 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006550
6551 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6552 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6553 be able to access the service anymore.
6554
6555 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6556 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6557
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006558 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006559 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6560 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006562 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6563 "redisp" keywords.
6564
6565 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6566 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6567
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006568 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006569
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006570
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006571option redis-check
6572 Use redis health checks for server testing
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | no | yes | yes
6575 Arguments : none
6576
6577 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6578 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6579 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6580 find the "+PONG" response message.
6581
6582 Example :
6583 option redis-check
6584
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006585 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006586
6587
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006588option smtpchk
6589option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6590 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006593 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006594 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6595 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6596 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6597
6598 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6599 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6600 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6601
6602 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6603 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6604 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6605 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6606 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6607 dead server.
6608
6609 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6610 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006611 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006612 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6613
6614 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6615 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6616 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6617 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006618 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006619
6620 Example :
6621 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6622
6623 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006626option socket-stats
6627no option socket-stats
6628
6629 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6631 yes | yes | yes | no
6632
6633 Arguments : none
6634
6635
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006636option splice-auto
6637no option splice-auto
6638 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6640 yes | yes | yes | yes
6641 Arguments : none
6642
6643 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6644 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006645 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006646 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006647 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006648 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6649 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6650 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6651 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6652
6653 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6654 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6655 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6656 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6657 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6658 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6659 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6660 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6661 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6662 keyword.
6663
6664 Example :
6665 option splice-auto
6666
6667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6669
6670 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6671 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6672
6673
6674option splice-request
6675no option splice-request
6676 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6678 yes | yes | yes | yes
6679 Arguments : none
6680
6681 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006682 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006683 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6684 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6685 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6686 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6687
6688 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6689
6690 Example :
6691 option splice-request
6692
6693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6695
6696 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6697 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6698
6699
6700option splice-response
6701no option splice-response
6702 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6704 yes | yes | yes | yes
6705 Arguments : none
6706
6707 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006708 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006709 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6710 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6711 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6712 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6713
6714 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6715
6716 Example :
6717 option splice-response
6718
6719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6721
6722 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6723 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6724
6725
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006726option spop-check
6727 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6729 no | no | no | yes
6730 Arguments : none
6731
6732 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6733 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6734 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6735 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6736
6737 Example :
6738 option spop-check
6739
6740 See also : "option httpchk"
6741
6742
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006743option srvtcpka
6744no option srvtcpka
6745 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6747 yes | no | yes | yes
6748 Arguments : none
6749
6750 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6751 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006752 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006753 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6754
6755 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6756 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6757 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6758 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6759
6760 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6761 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6762 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6763 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6764 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6765
6766 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6767
6768 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6769 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6770 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6771
6772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6774
6775 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6776
6777
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006778option ssl-hello-chk
6779 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782 Arguments : none
6783
6784 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6785 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6786 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6787 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6788 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6789 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6790 hello message.
6791
6792 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6793 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6794 messages, which is appreciable.
6795
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006796 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6797 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6798 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006799
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006800 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6801
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006802
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006803option tcp-check
6804 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6806 yes | no | yes | yes
6807
6808 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6809 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6810
6811 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6812 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6813 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6814
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006815 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006816 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6817 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6818 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6819 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6820 only.
6821
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006822 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006823 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6824 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6825 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6826 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6827
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006828 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006829 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
6830 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006831 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006832 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6833 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6834 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6835 the respective protocols.
6836 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006837 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006838
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006839 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6840 script.
6841
6842 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6843 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6844 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6845 The "comment" is of course optional.
6846
6847
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006848 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006849 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006850 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006851 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006852
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006853 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006854 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006855 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006856
6857 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6858 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006859 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006860 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006861 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006862 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006863 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006864 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006865 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6866 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006867 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006868 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6869 tcp-check expect string +OK
6870
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006871 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006872 (send many headers before analyzing)
6873 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006874 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006875 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6876 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6877 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6878 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006879 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006880
6881
6882 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6883
6884
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006885option tcp-smart-accept
6886no option tcp-smart-accept
6887 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6889 yes | yes | yes | no
6890 Arguments : none
6891
6892 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6893 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6894 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6895 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6896 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6897 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6898
6899 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6900 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6901 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6902 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6903
6904 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6905 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6906 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006907 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006908
6909 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6910 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6911 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6912
6913 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6914 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6915 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6916
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006917 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6918
6919
6920option tcp-smart-connect
6921no option tcp-smart-connect
6922 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | no | yes | yes
6925 Arguments : none
6926
6927 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6928 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6929 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6930 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6931 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6932
6933 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6934 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6935 complex.
6936
6937 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6938 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6939 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6940
6941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6943
6944 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6945
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006946
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006947option tcpka
6948 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | yes | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6954 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006955 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006956 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6957
6958 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6959 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6960 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6961 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6962
6963 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6964 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6965 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6966 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6967 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6968
6969 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6970
6971 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6972 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6973 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6974 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6975 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6976 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6977 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6978 backends.
6979
6980 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6981
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006982
6983option tcplog
6984 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006986 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006987 Arguments : none
6988
6989 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6990 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6991 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6992 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6993 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6994 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6995 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6996 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6997
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006998 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007000 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007001
7002
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007003option transparent
7004no option transparent
7005 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007007 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007008 Arguments : none
7009
7010 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7011 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7012 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7013 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7014 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7015 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7016 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7017 appropriate server.
7018
7019 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7020 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7021
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007022 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007023 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007024
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007025
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007026external-check command <command>
7027 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7029 yes | no | yes | yes
7030
7031 Arguments :
7032 <command> is the external command to run
7033
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007034 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7035
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007036 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007037
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007038 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7039 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7040 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7041 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7042 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7043 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007044
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007045 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7046
7047 Environment variables :
7048 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7049 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7050
7051 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7052
7053 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7054
7055 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7056 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7057 for a UNIX socket).
7058
7059 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7060
7061 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7062
7063 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7064
7065 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7066
7067 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7068
7069 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7070 socket).
7071
7072 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7073 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7074
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007075 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7076 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7077 failed.
7078
7079 Example :
7080 external-check command /bin/true
7081
7082 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7083
7084
7085external-check path <path>
7086 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7088 yes | no | yes | yes
7089
7090 Arguments :
7091 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7092
7093 The default path is "".
7094
7095 Example :
7096 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7097
7098 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7099 "external-check command"
7100
7101
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007102persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007103persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007104 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 yes | no | yes | yes
7107 Arguments :
7108 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007109 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7110 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007111
7112 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7113 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007114 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007115 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7116 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7117 forwarded to this server.
7118
7119 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7120 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7121 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007122 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007123 a single "listen" section.
7124
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007125 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7126 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7127 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7128
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007129 Example :
7130 listen tse-farm
7131 bind :3389
7132 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7133 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7134 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7135 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7136 persist rdp-cookie
7137 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007138 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007139 balance rdp-cookie
7140 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7141 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7142
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007143 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7144 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007145
7146
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007147rate-limit sessions <rate>
7148 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7150 yes | yes | yes | no
7151 Arguments :
7152 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7153 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7154
7155 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7156 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7157 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7158 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7159 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7160 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7161
7162 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7163 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7164 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7165 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7166
7167 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7168 listen smtp
7169 mode tcp
7170 bind :25
7171 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007172 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007173
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007174 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7175 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7176 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007177
7178 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7179
7180
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007181redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7182redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7183redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007184 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 no | yes | yes | yes
7187
7188 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007189 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007190
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007191 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007192 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007193 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7194 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7195 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007196
7197 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7198 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7199 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7200 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7201 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007202 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7203 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7204 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7205 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007206
7207 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7208 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7209 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7210 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7211 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7212 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007213 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007214 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007215 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7216 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7217 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007218
7219 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007220 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7221 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7222 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007223 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007224 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7225 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7226 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7227 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007228
7229 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007230 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007231
7232 - "drop-query"
7233 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7234 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7235 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7236 with a location-type redirect.
7237
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007238 - "append-slash"
7239 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7240 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7241 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7242 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7243
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007244 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7245 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7246 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7247 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7248 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7249 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7250 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7251
7252 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7253 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7254 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7255 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7256 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7257 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7258 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007259
7260 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7261 acl clear dst_port 80
7262 acl secure dst_port 8080
7263 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007264 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007265 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007266 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7267
7268 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007269 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7270 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7271 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007272 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007273
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007274 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7275 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7276 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7277
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007278 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007279 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007280
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007281 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007282 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7283 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7284 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007286 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007287
7288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007289redisp (deprecated)
7290redispatch (deprecated)
7291 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007294 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007295
7296 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7297 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7298 be able to access the service anymore.
7299
7300 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7301 redistribute them to a working server.
7302
7303 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7304 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7305 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007307 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7308 "option redispatch" instead.
7309
7310 See also : "option redispatch"
7311
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007312
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007313reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007314 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7316 no | yes | yes | yes
7317 Arguments :
7318 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7319 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007320 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007321
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007322 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7323 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7324
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007325 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7326 the last header of an HTTP request.
7327
7328 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7329 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7330 responses.
7331
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007332 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7333 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7334 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7335
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007336 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7337 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007338
7339
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007340reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7341reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007342 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7344 no | yes | yes | yes
7345 Arguments :
7346 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7347 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7348 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7349 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7350 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7351 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7352 ignores case.
7353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007354 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7355 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007357 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7358 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7359 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7360 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007361 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362
7363 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7364 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7365
7366 Example :
7367 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7368 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7369 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7370
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007371 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7372 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007373
7374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007375reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7376reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007377 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7379 no | yes | yes | yes
7380 Arguments :
7381 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7382 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7383 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7384 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7385 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7386 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7387
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007388 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7389 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7390
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007391 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7392 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7393 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7394 next servers.
7395
7396 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7397 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7398 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7399
7400 Example :
7401 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7402 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7403 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7404
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007405 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7406 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007407
7408
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007409reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7410reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007411 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7413 no | yes | yes | yes
7414 Arguments :
7415 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7416 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7417 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7418 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7419 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7420 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7421 case.
7422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007423 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7424 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7425
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007426 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7427 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7428 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7429 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007430 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007431
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007432 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007433 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007434 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007435
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007436 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7437 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7438
7439 Example :
7440 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7441 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7442 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7443
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007444 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7445 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007446
7447
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007448reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7449reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007450 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7452 no | yes | yes | yes
7453 Arguments :
7454 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7455 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7456 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7457 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7458 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7459 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7460 case.
7461
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007462 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7463 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7464
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007465 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7466 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7467 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7468 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7469
7470 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7471 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7472
7473 Example :
7474 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7475 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7476 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7477 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7478
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007479 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7480 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007481
7482
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007483reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7484reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007485 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7487 no | yes | yes | yes
7488 Arguments :
7489 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7490 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7491 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7492 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7493 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7494 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7495
7496 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7497 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7498 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7499 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007500 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007501
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007502 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7503 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7504
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007505 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7506 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7507 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7508
7509 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7510 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7511 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7512 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7513 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7514
7515 Example :
7516 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007517 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007518 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7519 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7520
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007521 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7522 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007523
7524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007525reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7526reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007527 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7529 no | yes | yes | yes
7530 Arguments :
7531 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7532 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7533 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7534 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7535 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7536 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7537 ignores case.
7538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007539 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7540 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7541
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007542 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7543 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007544 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7545 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7546 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007547 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7548 not set.
7549
7550 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7551 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7552 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7553 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7554 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007556 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007557 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007558 # block all others.
7559 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7560 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7561
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007562 # block bad guys
7563 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7564 reqitarpit . if badguys
7565
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007566 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7567 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007568
7569
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007570retries <value>
7571 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7573 yes | no | yes | yes
7574 Arguments :
7575 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7576 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7577 default value is 3.
7578
7579 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7580 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7581 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7582
7583 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007584 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7585 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007586
7587 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7588 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7589
7590 See also : "option redispatch"
7591
7592
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007593rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007594 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7596 no | yes | yes | yes
7597 Arguments :
7598 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7599 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007600 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007601
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007602 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7603 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7604
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007605 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7606 the last header of an HTTP response.
7607
7608 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7609 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7610 responses.
7611
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007612 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7613 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007614
7615
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007616rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7617rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007618 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 no | yes | yes | yes
7621 Arguments :
7622 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7623 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7624 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7625 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7626 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7627 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7628 ignores case.
7629
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007630 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7631 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7632
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007633 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7634 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007635 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007636 client.
7637
7638 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7639 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7640 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7641
7642 Example :
7643 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007644 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007646 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7647 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007648
7649
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007650rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7651rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007652 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7654 no | yes | yes | yes
7655 Arguments :
7656 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7657 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7658 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7659 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7660 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7661 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7662 ignores case.
7663
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007664 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7665 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7666
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007667 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7668 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7669 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7670 case-sensitive.
7671
7672 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007673 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7674 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7675 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007676
7677 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7678 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7679
7680 Example :
7681 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7682 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7683
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007684 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7685 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686
7687
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007688rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7689rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007690 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 no | yes | yes | yes
7693 Arguments :
7694 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7695 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7696 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7697 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7698 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7699 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7700 ignores case.
7701
7702 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7703 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7704 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7705 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007706 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007708 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7709 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7710
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007711 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7712 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7713 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7714
7715 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7716 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7717 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7718 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7719 are not case-sensitive.
7720
7721 Example :
7722 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7723 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7724
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007725 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7726 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007727
7728
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007729server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007730 Declare a server in a backend
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 no | no | yes | yes
7733 Arguments :
7734 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007735 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007736 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007737
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007738 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7739 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7740 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7741 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007742 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7743 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7744 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7745 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7746 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007747 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7748 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7749 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7750 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7751 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7752 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7753 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007754 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007755 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7756 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7757 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7758 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7759 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7760 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007761 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7762 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007763 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7764 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007766 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7768 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7769 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7770 adding this value to the client's port.
7771
7772 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7773 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007774 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007775
7776 Examples :
7777 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7778 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007779 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007780 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7781 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7782 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007783
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007784 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7785 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7786 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7787 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7788 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7789
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007790 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7791 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007793server-state-file-name [<file>]
7794 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7795 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7796 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7797 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7798 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7799 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7800
7801 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7802 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7803
7804 global
7805 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7806
7807 backend bk
7808 load-server-state-from-file
7809
7810 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7811 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007812
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007813server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7814 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7815 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 no | no | yes | yes
7818
7819 Arguments:
7820 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7821
7822 <num | range>
7823 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7824 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7825 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7826 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7827
7828 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7829
7830 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7831
7832 <params*>
7833 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7834 keyword.
7835
7836 Examples:
7837 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7838 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7839 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7840
7841 # or
7842 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7843
7844 # would be equivalent to:
7845 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7846 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7847 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7848
7849
7850
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007851source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007852source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007853source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007854 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 yes | no | yes | yes
7857 Arguments :
7858 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7859 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007860
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007861 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007862 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7863 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7864 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7865 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7866 supported prefixes are :
7867 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7868 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7869 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007870 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007871 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7872 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007873
7874 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7875 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007876 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7877 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7878 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007879
7880 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7881 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7882 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7883 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7884 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7885 <addr>.
7886
7887 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7888 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7889 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7890 port.
7891
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007892 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7893 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7894 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7895 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007896 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007897 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7898 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7899 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7900 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7901 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7902 HTTP header.
7903
7904 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7905 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007906 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007907 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7908 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7909 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7910 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7911 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7912 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7913 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7914
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007915 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7916 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7917 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7918 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7919 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7920 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7921
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007922 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7923 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7924 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7925 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7926
7927 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7928 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7929 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7930 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7931 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7932 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7933
7934 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7935 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7936 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7937 there are two methods :
7938
7939 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7940 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7941 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7942 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7943 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7944 of the client ranges may be used.
7945
7946 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7947 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7948 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7949 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7950 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7951 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7952 same session.
7953
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7955 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7956 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007957 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007958
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007959 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7960
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007961 Examples :
7962 backend private
7963 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7964 source 192.168.1.200
7965
7966 backend transparent_ssl1
7967 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7968 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7969
7970 backend transparent_ssl2
7971 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7972 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7973 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7974
7975 backend transparent_ssl3
7976 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7977 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7978 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7979
7980 backend transparent_smtp
7981 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7982 # with Tproxy version 4.
7983 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7984
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007985 backend transparent_http
7986 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7987 # proxy.
7988 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007990 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007991 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007993
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007994srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7995 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7997 yes | no | yes | yes
7998 Arguments :
7999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8001 as explained at the top of this document.
8002
8003 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8004 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8005 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8006 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8007 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8008 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8009 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8010
8011 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8012 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8013 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8014 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8015 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008016 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008017 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008018 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008019
8020 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8021 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8022 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8023 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8024 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8025 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8026
8027 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8028 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8029
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008030 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8031 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008032
8033
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008034stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8035 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008037 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008038
8039 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8040 matched.
8041
8042 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8043 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8044
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008045 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8046 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008047 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008048
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008049 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8050 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8051 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8052 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008053
8054 Example :
8055 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8056 backend stats_localhost
8057 stats enable
8058 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8059
8060 Example :
8061 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8062 backend stats_auth
8063 stats enable
8064 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8065 stats admin if TRUE
8066
8067 Example :
8068 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8069 userlist stats-auth
8070 group admin users admin
8071 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8072 group readonly users haproxy
8073 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8074
8075 backend stats_auth
8076 stats enable
8077 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8078 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8079 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8080 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8081
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008082 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8083 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8084 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008085
8086
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008087stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8088 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008090 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091 Arguments :
8092 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8093
8094 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8095
8096 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8097 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8098 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8099 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8100 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8101 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8102
8103 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8104 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8105 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008106 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008107
8108 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8109 report using "stats scope".
8110
8111 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8112 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8113 unobvious parameters.
8114
8115 Example :
8116 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8117 backend public_www
8118 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8119 stats enable
8120 stats hide-version
8121 stats scope .
8122 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008123 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008124 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8125 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8126
8127 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8128 backend private_monitoring
8129 stats enable
8130 stats uri /admin?stats
8131 stats refresh 5s
8132
8133 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8134
8135
8136stats enable
8137 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140 Arguments : none
8141
8142 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8143 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8144 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8145 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8146 - stats auth : no authentication
8147 - stats scope : no restriction
8148
8149 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8150 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8151 unobvious parameters.
8152
8153 Example :
8154 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8155 backend public_www
8156 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8157 stats enable
8158 stats hide-version
8159 stats scope .
8160 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008161 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8163 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8164
8165 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8166 backend private_monitoring
8167 stats enable
8168 stats uri /admin?stats
8169 stats refresh 5s
8170
8171 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8172
8173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008174stats hide-version
8175 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008177 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008179
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008180 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8181 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8182 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8183 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8184 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8185 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008187 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8188 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8189 unobvious parameters.
8190
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008191 Example :
8192 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8193 backend public_www
8194 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008195 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008196 stats hide-version
8197 stats scope .
8198 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008200 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8201 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008202
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008203 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8204 backend private_monitoring
8205 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008206 stats uri /admin?stats
8207 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008208
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008209 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008210
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008211
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008212stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8214 Access control for statistics
8215
8216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 no | no | yes | yes
8218
8219 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8220 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8221 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8222 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8223 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8224 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8225
8226 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8227 instance.
8228
8229 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8230 about ACL usage.
8231
8232
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008233stats realm <realm>
8234 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008236 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008237 Arguments :
8238 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8239 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8240 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8241
8242 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8243 using a backslash ('\').
8244
8245 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8246 only related to authentication.
8247
8248 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8249 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8250 unobvious parameters.
8251
8252 Example :
8253 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8254 backend public_www
8255 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8256 stats enable
8257 stats hide-version
8258 stats scope .
8259 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008260 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008261 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8262 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8263
8264 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8265 backend private_monitoring
8266 stats enable
8267 stats uri /admin?stats
8268 stats refresh 5s
8269
8270 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8271
8272
8273stats refresh <delay>
8274 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008276 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008277 Arguments :
8278 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8279 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8280 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8281 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8282 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8283 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8284
8285 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8286 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8287 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8288 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8289
8290 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8291 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8292 unobvious parameters.
8293
8294 Example :
8295 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8296 backend public_www
8297 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8298 stats enable
8299 stats hide-version
8300 stats scope .
8301 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008302 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008303 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8304 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8305
8306 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8307 backend private_monitoring
8308 stats enable
8309 stats uri /admin?stats
8310 stats refresh 5s
8311
8312 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8313
8314
8315stats scope { <name> | "." }
8316 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008318 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008319 Arguments :
8320 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8321 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8322 section in which the statement appears.
8323
8324 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8325 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8326 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8327 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8328 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8329 exists.
8330
8331 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8332 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8333 unobvious parameters.
8334
8335 Example :
8336 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8337 backend public_www
8338 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8339 stats enable
8340 stats hide-version
8341 stats scope .
8342 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008343 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008344 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8345 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8346
8347 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8348 backend private_monitoring
8349 stats enable
8350 stats uri /admin?stats
8351 stats refresh 5s
8352
8353 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8354
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008355
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008356stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008357 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008359 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008360
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008361 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008362 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8363
8364 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8365 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8366
8367 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8368 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008369 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008370
8371 Example :
8372 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8373 backend private_monitoring
8374 stats enable
8375 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8376 stats uri /admin?stats
8377 stats refresh 5s
8378
8379 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8380 global section.
8381
8382
8383stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008384 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8386 yes | yes | yes | yes
8387 Arguments : none
8388
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008389 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008390 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8391 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8392 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8393 - IP (socket, server)
8394 - cookie (backend, server)
8395
8396 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8397 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008398 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008399
8400 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8401
8402
8403stats show-node [ <name> ]
8404 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008406 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008407 Arguments:
8408 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8409 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8410
8411 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8412 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008413 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008414
8415 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8416 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8417 unobvious parameters.
8418
8419 Example:
8420 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8421 backend private_monitoring
8422 stats enable
8423 stats show-node Europe-1
8424 stats uri /admin?stats
8425 stats refresh 5s
8426
8427 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8428 section.
8429
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008430
8431stats uri <prefix>
8432 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008434 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008435 Arguments :
8436 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8437 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8438 query string.
8439
8440 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8441 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8442 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8443 possible to reach it in the application.
8444
8445 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008446 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008447 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8448 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8449 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8450 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8451
8452 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8453 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8454 an address or a port to statistics only.
8455
8456 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8457 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8458 unobvious parameters.
8459
8460 Example :
8461 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8462 backend public_www
8463 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8464 stats enable
8465 stats hide-version
8466 stats scope .
8467 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008468 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008469 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8470 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8471
8472 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8473 backend private_monitoring
8474 stats enable
8475 stats uri /admin?stats
8476 stats refresh 5s
8477
8478 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8479
8480
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008481stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8482 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008484 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008485
8486 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008487 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008488 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008489 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008490 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8491
8492 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8493 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8494 the "stick-table" statement.
8495
8496 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8497 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8498 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8499 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8500 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8501
8502 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8503 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8504 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8505 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8506 transformation rules.
8507
8508 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8509 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8510 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8511 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8512 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8513 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8514 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8515
8516 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8517 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8518 ACL based conditions.
8519
8520 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8521 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8522 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8523 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8524
8525 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8526 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8527 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8528 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8529
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008530 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8531 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008533
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008534 Example :
8535 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8536 # last 30 minutes
8537 backend pop
8538 mode tcp
8539 balance roundrobin
8540 stick store-request src
8541 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8542 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8543 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8544
8545 backend smtp
8546 mode tcp
8547 balance roundrobin
8548 stick match src table pop
8549 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8550 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8551
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008552 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008553 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008554
8555
8556stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8557 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8559 no | no | yes | yes
8560
8561 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8562 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8563 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8564 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8565
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008566 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8567 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008568 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008569
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008570 Examples :
8571 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008572 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573
8574 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8575 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8576 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8577
8578
8579 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8580 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8581 backend http
8582 mode http
8583 balance roundrobin
8584 stick on src table https
8585 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8586 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8587 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8588
8589 backend https
8590 mode tcp
8591 balance roundrobin
8592 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8593 stick on src
8594 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8595 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8596
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008597 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008598
8599
8600stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8601 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8603 no | no | yes | yes
8604
8605 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008606 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008607 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008608 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008609 server is selected.
8610
8611 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8612 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8613 the "stick-table" statement.
8614
8615 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8616 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8617 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8618 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8619 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8620 address.
8621
8622 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8623 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8624 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8625 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8626 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8627 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8628 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8629 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8630 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8631 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8632
8633 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8634 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8635 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8636 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8637 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8638 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8639 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8640
8641 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8642 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8643 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8644 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8645
8646 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8647 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8648 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8649 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8650 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8651 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008652 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8653 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8654 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8655 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8656 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8657 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008658
8659 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8660 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8661 the request.
8662
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008663 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8664 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008665 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008666
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008667 Example :
8668 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8669 # last 30 minutes
8670 backend pop
8671 mode tcp
8672 balance roundrobin
8673 stick store-request src
8674 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8675 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8676 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8677
8678 backend smtp
8679 mode tcp
8680 balance roundrobin
8681 stick match src table pop
8682 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8683 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008685 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008686 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008687
8688
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008689stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008690 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8691 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008692 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008694 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008695
8696 Arguments :
8697 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8698 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8699 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8700 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8701
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008702 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8703 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8704 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8705 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8706
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008707 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8708 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8709 instance.
8710
8711 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8712 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8713 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8714 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8715 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8716 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008717 to 32 characters.
8718
8719 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8720 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8721 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008722 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008723 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8724 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008725
8726 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008727 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8728 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008729 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8730 increase.
8731
8732 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008733 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8734 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8735 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008736
8737 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8738 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8739 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8740 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008741 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008742 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8743 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8744 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8745 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8746 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8747 parameter (see below).
8748
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008749 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8750 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8751 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8752 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8753 soft restart.
8754
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008755 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8756 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008757
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008758 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8759 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8760 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8761 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008762 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008763 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008764 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8765 if not expiration delay is specified.
8766
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008767 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8768 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8769 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8770 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008771 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8772 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8773 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8774 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8775 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8776 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8777 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8778 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8779 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8780 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8781 types and their arguments.
8782
8783 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8784 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8785 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8786 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8787
8788 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8789 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8790 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008791 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008792
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008793 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8794 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8795 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008797 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008799
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008800 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8801 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8802 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8803 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8804
8805 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8806 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8807 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8808 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8809 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8810 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8811
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008812 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8813 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8814 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8815 they were received.
8816
8817 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8818 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8819 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8820 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8821 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8822
8823 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8824 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8826 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8827 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8828
8829 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8830 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8831 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8832
8833 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8836 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8837 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8838
8839 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8840 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8841 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8842 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8843 the client side.
8844
8845 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8846 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8847 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8848 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8849 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8850 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8851 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8852
8853 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8854 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8855 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8856 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8857 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8858 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008859 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008860
8861 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8862 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8863 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8864 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8865 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8866 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8867
8868 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008869 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008870 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8871 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8872
8873 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8874 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8875 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8876 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8877 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8878 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8879 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8880 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8881 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8882 recommended for better fairness.
8883
8884 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008885 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008886 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8887 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8888
8889 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8890 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8891 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8892 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8893 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8894 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8895 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8896 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8897 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8898 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008899
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008900 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8901 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008902 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8903 reference it.
8904
8905 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8906 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008907 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8908 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8909 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008910
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008911 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8912 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8913 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8914 something that can be ignored.
8915
8916 Example:
8917 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8918 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8919 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8920 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8921
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008922 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008923 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008924
8925
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008926stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008927 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8929 no | no | yes | yes
8930
8931 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008932 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008933 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008934 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008935 server is selected.
8936
8937 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8938 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8939 the "stick-table" statement.
8940
8941 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8942 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8943 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8944 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8945
8946 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8947 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8948 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8949 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8950 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8951 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008952 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008953 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8954 rules.
8955
8956 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8957 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8958 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8959 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8960 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8961 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8962 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8963
8964 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8965 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8966 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8967 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8968
8969 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8970 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8971 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8972 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8973 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8974 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008975 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8976 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8977 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8978 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8979 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8980 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8981 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8982 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8983 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008984
8985 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8986
8987 Example :
8988 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8989 backend https
8990 mode tcp
8991 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008992 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008993 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008994
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008995 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8996 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8997
8998 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8999 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9000 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9001
9002 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9003 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009004
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009005 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9006 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9007 # at offset 44.
9008
9009 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9010 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9011
9012 # Learn on response if server hello.
9013 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009014
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009015 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9016 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9017
9018 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9019 extraction.
9020
9021
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009022tcp-check connect [params*]
9023 Opens a new connection
9024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9025 no | no | yes | yes
9026
9027 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9028 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9029 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9030
9031 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9032 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9033 of the sequence.
9034
9035 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9036 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9037 do.
9038
9039 Parameters :
9040 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9041 use the TCP connection.
9042
9043 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9044 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9045 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9046
9047 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9048
9049 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9050
9051 Examples:
9052 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9053 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9054 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9055 option tcp-check
9056 tcp-check connect
9057 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9058 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9059 tcp-check send \r\n
9060 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9061 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9062 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9063 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9064 tcp-check send \r\n
9065 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9066 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9067
9068 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9069 option tcp-check
9070 tcp-check connect port 110
9071 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9072 tcp-check connect port 143
9073 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9074 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9075
9076 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9077
9078
9079tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9082 no | no | yes | yes
9083
9084 Arguments :
9085 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9086 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9087 binary.
9088 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9089 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9090 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9091
9092 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9093 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9094 with the usual backslash ('\').
9095 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009096 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009097 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9098 used upper or lower case.
9099
9100
9101 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9102
9103 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9104 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9105 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9106 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9107 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9108 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9109 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9110 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9111
9112 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9113 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9114 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9115 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9116 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9117 expression.
9118
9119 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9120 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9121 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9122 this exact hexadecimal string.
9123 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9124
9125 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9126 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9127 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9128 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9129 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9130 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9131 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9132 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9133 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9134 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9135 the null character.
9136
9137 Examples :
9138 # perform a POP check
9139 option tcp-check
9140 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9141
9142 # perform an IMAP check
9143 option tcp-check
9144 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9145
9146 # look for the redis master server
9147 option tcp-check
9148 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009149 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009150 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9151 tcp-check expect string role:master
9152 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9153 tcp-check expect string +OK
9154
9155
9156 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9157 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9158
9159
9160tcp-check send <data>
9161 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9163 no | no | yes | yes
9164
9165 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9166 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9167
9168 Examples :
9169 # look for the redis master server
9170 option tcp-check
9171 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9172 tcp-check expect string role:master
9173
9174 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9175 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9176
9177
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009178tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9179 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009180 tcp health check
9181 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9182 no | no | yes | yes
9183
9184 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9185 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009186 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009187 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9188 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9189 hexadecimal string.
9190 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9191
9192 Examples :
9193 # redis check in binary
9194 option tcp-check
9195 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9196 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9197
9198
9199 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9200 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9201
9202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009203tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9204 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9206 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009208 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9209 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009211 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009212
9213 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9214 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009215 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9216 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9217 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9218 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9219 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9220 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009222 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9223 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9224 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9225 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009226
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009227 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009228 - accept :
9229 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9230 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9231 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009233 - reject :
9234 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9235 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9236 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9237 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9238 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9239 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9240 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9241 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9242 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9243 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9244 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009245 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009246
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009247 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9248 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9249 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9250 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9251 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9252 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9253 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9254 hosts.
9255
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009256 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9257 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9258 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9259 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9260 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9261 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9262 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9263 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9264
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009265 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9266 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9267 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9268 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9269 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9270 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9271 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9272 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9273 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009274 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9275 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009276
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009277 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009278 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009279 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9280 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9281 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9282 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9283 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9284 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9285 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9286 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9287 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9288 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9289 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9290 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009292 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009293 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009294 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009295 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009296 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9297 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9298 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009299
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009300 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9301 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9302 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9303 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009305 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9306 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9307 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9308 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9309 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009310 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9311 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9312 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9313 layer7 information is extracted.
9314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009315 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9316 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9317 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9318 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9319 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009320
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009321 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9322 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9323 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9324 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9325
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009326 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9327 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9328 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9329 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9330
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009331 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9332 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9333 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9334 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9335 continues.
9336
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009337 - set-src <expr> :
9338 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9339 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9340 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9341 set-src"
9342
9343 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9344 followed by some converters.
9345
9346 Example:
9347
9348 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9349
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009350 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9351 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009352
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009353 - set-src-port <expr> :
9354 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9355 expression.
9356
9357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9358 followed by some converters.
9359
9360 Example:
9361
9362 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9363
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009364 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9365 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9366 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009367
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009368 - set-dst <expr> :
9369 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9370 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9371 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9372 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9373 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9374
9375 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9376 followed by some converters.
9377
9378 Example:
9379
9380 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9381 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9382
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009383 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9384 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9385
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009386 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9387 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9388 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9389 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9390
9391
9392 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9393 followed by some converters.
9394
9395 Example:
9396
9397 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9398
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009399 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9400 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9401 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9402
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009403 - "silent-drop" :
9404 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009405 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009406 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9407 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9408 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9409 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9410 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009411 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9412 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009413 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9414 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009415 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009416 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9417 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9418 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9419 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009421 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9422 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9423 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009424
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009425 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9426 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9427 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009428
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009429 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009430 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009431 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009432
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9434 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9435 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009436
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009437 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009438 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9439 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009440
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009441 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9442
9443 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9444
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009445 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9446
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009447 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009448
9449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009450tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9451 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009453 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009454 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009455 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9456 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009458 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009459
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009460 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009461 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9462 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9463 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9464 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009466 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9467 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9468 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9469 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009470 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9471 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9472 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9473 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9474 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9475 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009476 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009477 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9480 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9481 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9482 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009483
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009484 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009485 - accept : the request is accepted
9486 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9487 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009488 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009489 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009490 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009491 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009492 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009493 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009494 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009495 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009496 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009497
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009498 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9499 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009500
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009501 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9502 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9503 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9504 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9505 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9506 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009508 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009509 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9510 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009513 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9514 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9515 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9516 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009517 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9518 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9519 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009520
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009521 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009522 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9523 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9524 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009525
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009526 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009527 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9528 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009529
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009530 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9531 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009532 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009533 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9534 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009535 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009536 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009537 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009538 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9539 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009540 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009541 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9542 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009543
9544 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9545 followed by some converters.
9546
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009547 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9548 <var-name>.
9549
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009550 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9551 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9552 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9553 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9554 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9555
9556 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9557 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9558 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9559 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9560 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9561 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9562 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9563 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9564 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9565 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9566 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9567
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009568 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9569 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9570 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9571 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9572 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9573
9574 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9575
9576 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9577
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009578 Example:
9579
9580 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009581 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009582
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009583 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009584 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9585 # and reject everything else.
9586 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9587 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009588 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 tcp-request content reject
9590
9591 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009592 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9593 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9594 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009595 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009596
9597 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9598 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9599 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009600 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009601 tcp-request content reject
9602
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009603 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009604 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009605 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009606 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009607 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9608 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009609
9610 Example:
9611 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9612 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009613 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009614
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009615 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009616 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009617
9618 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009619 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009620 # protecting all our sites
9621 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009622 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9623 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009624 ...
9625 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9626
9627 backend http_dynamic
9628 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009629 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009630 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009631 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009632 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009633 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009634 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009636 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009637
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009638 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9639 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009640
9641
9642tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9643 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009645 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009646 Arguments :
9647 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9649 as explained at the top of this document.
9650
9651 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9652 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9653 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9654 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9655 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9656
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009657 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9658 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9659 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9660 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9661
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009662 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9663 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009664 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009665 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009666 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9667 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9668 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9669 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009670
9671 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9672 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9673 it pass through unaffected.
9674
9675 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9676 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9677 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009678 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9680 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009681 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9682 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9683 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009684
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009685 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009686 "timeout client".
9687
9688
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009689tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9690 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 no | no | yes | yes
9693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009694 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9695 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009696
9697 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9698
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009699 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009700 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9701 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009702 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9703 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009704
9705 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9706
9707 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9708 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9709 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9710 inserted.
9711
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009712 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009713 - accept :
9714 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9715 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9716 the rules evaluation.
9717
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009718 - close :
9719 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9720 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9721 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9722 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9723 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9724 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009725 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009726 protocols.
9727
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009728 - reject :
9729 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9730 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009731 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009732
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009733 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9734 Sets a variable.
9735
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009736 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9737 Unsets a variable.
9738
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009739 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9740 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9741 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9742 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9743
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009744 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9745 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9746 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9747 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9748
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009749 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9750 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9751 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9752 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9753 continues.
9754
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009755 - "silent-drop" :
9756 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009757 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009758 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9759 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9760 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9761 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9762 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009763 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9764 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009765 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9766 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009767 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009768 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9769 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9770 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9771 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9772
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009773 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9774 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9775
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009776 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9777 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9778 for changing the default action to a reject.
9779
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009780 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9781 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9782 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9783 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009784 period.
9785
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009786 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9787 declared inline.
9788
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009789 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9790 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009791 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009792 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9793 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009794 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009795 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009796 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009797 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9798 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009799 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009800 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9801 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009802
9803 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9804 followed by some converters.
9805
9806 Example:
9807
9808 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9809
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009810 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9811 <var-name>.
9812
9813 Example:
9814
9815 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9816
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009817 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9818 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9819 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9820 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9821 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9822
9823 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9824
9825 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9826
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009827 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9828
9829 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9830
9831
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009832tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9833 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9835 no | yes | yes | no
9836 Arguments :
9837 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9838 below.
9839
9840 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9841
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009842 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009843 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9844 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9845 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9846 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9847 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9848 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9849 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009850 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009851 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9852 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9853 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9854 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9855 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9856 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9857 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9858 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9859 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9860 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9861 instead.
9862
9863 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9864 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9865 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9866 rules which may be inserted.
9867
9868 Several types of actions are supported :
9869 - accept : the request is accepted
9870 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9871 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9872 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009873 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009874 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9875 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009876 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009877 - silent-drop
9878
9879 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9880 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9881 sections for a complete description.
9882
9883 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9884 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9885 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9886
9887 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9888 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9889 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9890 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9891 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9892
9893 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9894 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9895
9896 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9897 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9898 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9899
9900 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9901 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9902 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9903
9904 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9905 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9906 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9907
9908 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9909 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9910 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9911
9912 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9913
9914 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9915
9916
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009917tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9918 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 no | no | yes | yes
9921 Arguments :
9922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9924 as explained at the top of this document.
9925
9926 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9927
9928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009929timeout check <timeout>
9930 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9931 established.
9932
9933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9934 yes | no | yes | yes
9935 Arguments:
9936 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9937 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9938 as explained at the top of this document.
9939
9940 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9941 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009942 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009943 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009944 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9945 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9946 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009947
9948 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9949 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9950
9951 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9952 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009953 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009954
9955 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9956 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9957 forget about it.
9958
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009959 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9960 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009961
9962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009963timeout client <timeout>
9964timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9965 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9967 yes | yes | yes | no
9968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009969 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9971 as explained at the top of this document.
9972
9973 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9974 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9975 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009976 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9977 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9978 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9979 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009980 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9981 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9982 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009983 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009984 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009985 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9986 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009987 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9988 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009989
9990 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9991 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9992 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9993 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9994 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9995 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9996
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009997 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009999 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10000 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10001 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10002
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010003 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10004 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010005
10006
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010007timeout client-fin <timeout>
10008 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10010 yes | yes | yes | no
10011 Arguments :
10012 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10013 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10014 as explained at the top of this document.
10015
10016 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10017 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10018 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10019 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10020 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10021 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10022 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010023 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10024 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10025 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010026
10027 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10028 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10029 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10030
10031 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10032
10033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010034timeout connect <timeout>
10035timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10036 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 yes | no | yes | yes
10039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010040 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10042 as explained at the top of this document.
10043
10044 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010045 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010046 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010047 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010048 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10049 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010050
10051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10053 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10054 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10055 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10056 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10057
10058 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10059 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10060 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10061
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010062 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10063 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010064
10065
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010066timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10067 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10069 yes | yes | yes | yes
10070 Arguments :
10071 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10072 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10073 as explained at the top of this document.
10074
10075 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10076 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10077 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10078 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10079 once the request has started to present itself.
10080
10081 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10082 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10083 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10084 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10085 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10086
10087 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10088 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10089 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10090 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10091
10092 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10093 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010094 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010095 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10096 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010097 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010098
10099 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10100 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10101 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10102 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10103
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010104 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10105 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010106 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10107
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010108 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10109
10110
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010111timeout http-request <timeout>
10112 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010115 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010116 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10118 as explained at the top of this document.
10119
10120 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10121 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10122 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10123 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10124 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10125 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10126 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010127 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10128 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10129 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10130 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010131 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010132 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10133 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010134
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010135 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10136 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10137 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10138 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10139 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010140 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010141
10142 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10143 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010144 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010145 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10146 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10147
10148 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010149 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10150 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10151 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010152
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010153 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010154 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010155
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156
10157timeout queue <timeout>
10158 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10160 yes | no | yes | yes
10161 Arguments :
10162 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10164 as explained at the top of this document.
10165
10166 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10167 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10168 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10169 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10170 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10171
10172 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10173 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10174 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10175 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10176
10177 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10178
10179
10180timeout server <timeout>
10181timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10182 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10184 yes | no | yes | yes
10185 Arguments :
10186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10188 as explained at the top of this document.
10189
10190 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10191 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10192 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10193 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10194 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10195 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10196 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10197
10198 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10199 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10200 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10201 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10202 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010203 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010204 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010205 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10206 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010207 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10208 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010209
10210 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10211 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10212 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10213 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10214 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10215 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10216
10217 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10218 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10219 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10220
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010221 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010222
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010223
10224timeout server-fin <timeout>
10225 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 yes | no | yes | yes
10228 Arguments :
10229 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10230 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10231 as explained at the top of this document.
10232
10233 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10234 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10235 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10236 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10237 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10238 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10239 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10240 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10241 situations, it should not be needed.
10242
10243 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10244 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10245 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10246
10247 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010249
10250timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010251 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10253 yes | yes | yes | yes
10254 Arguments :
10255 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10256 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10257 as explained at the top of this document.
10258
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010259 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10260 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10261 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10262 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010263
10264 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10265 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10266 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10267 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010268 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010269
10270 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10271
10272
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010273timeout tunnel <timeout>
10274 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | no | yes | yes
10277 Arguments :
10278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10280 as explained at the top of this document.
10281
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010282 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010283 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10284 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10285 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10287 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010288 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10289 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10290 specified.
10291
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010292 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10293 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10294 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10295 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10296 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10297 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10298 state.
10299
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010300 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10301 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10302 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10303 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010304 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010305
10306 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10307 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10308 forget about it.
10309
10310 Example :
10311 defaults http
10312 option http-server-close
10313 timeout connect 5s
10314 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010315 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010316 timeout server 30s
10317 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10318
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010319 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010320
10321
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010322transparent (deprecated)
10323 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010325 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010326 Arguments : none
10327
10328 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10329 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10330 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10331 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10332 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10333 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10334 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10335 appropriate server.
10336
10337 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10338
10339 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10340 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10341
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010342 See also: "option transparent"
10343
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010344unique-id-format <string>
10345 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10347 yes | yes | yes | no
10348 Arguments :
10349 <string> is a log-format string.
10350
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010351 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10352 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10353 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10354 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010355
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010356 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10357 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10358 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10359 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10360 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10361 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10362 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10363 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010364
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010365 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10366 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010367
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010368 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010369
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010370 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010371
10372 will generate:
10373
10374 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10375
10376 See also: "unique-id-header"
10377
10378unique-id-header <name>
10379 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10381 yes | yes | yes | no
10382 Arguments :
10383 <name> is the name of the header.
10384
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010385 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10386 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010387
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010388 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010389
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010390 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010391 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10392
10393 will generate:
10394
10395 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10396
10397 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010398
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010399use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010400 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10402 no | yes | yes | no
10403 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010404 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10405 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010406
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010407 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10408 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010409
10410 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10411 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10412 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010413 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010414 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010415 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10416 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010417
10418 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10419 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10420 assign the backend.
10421
10422 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10423 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10424 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10425 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10426 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10427 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10428
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010429 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010430 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010431 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10432 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10433 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10434
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010435 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10436 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10437 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10438 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10439 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10440 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10441 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10442 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10443 cannot be forced from the request.
10444
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010445 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010446 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10447 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10448
10449 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10450 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010451
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010452
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010453use-server <server> if <condition>
10454use-server <server> unless <condition>
10455 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10457 no | no | yes | yes
10458 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010459 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010460
10461 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10462
10463 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10464 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10465 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10466
10467 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10468 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10469 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10470 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10471 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10472 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10473 matches will assign the server.
10474
10475 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10476 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10477 with the next rules until one matches.
10478
10479 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10480 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10481 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10482 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10483
10484 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10485 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10486 stripped.
10487
10488 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10489 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10490 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10491 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10492
10493 Example :
10494 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10495 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10496 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10497 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10498 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10499 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010500 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010501 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10502 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010504 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100105075. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010508--------------------------
10509
10510The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10511depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10512settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10513written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10514described in this section.
10515
10516
105175.1. Bind options
10518-----------------
10519
10520The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10521as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10522no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10523parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10524while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10525provided immediately after the setting name.
10526
10527The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10528
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010529accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10530 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10531 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10532 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10533 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10534 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10535 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10536 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10537 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10538 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010539 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10540 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10541 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010542
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010543accept-proxy
10544 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010545 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10546 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010547 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10548 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10549 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10550 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010551 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010552 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10553 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010554 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10555 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010556
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010557allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010558 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010559 due to security considerations.
10560
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010561alpn <protocols>
10562 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10563 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10564 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10565 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10566 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010567 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10568 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10569 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10570 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10571 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10572 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10573 preference, like below :
10574
10575 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010576
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010577backlog <backlog>
10578 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10579 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10580
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010581curves <curves>
10582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10583 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10584 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10585 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10586 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10587 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10588
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010589ecdhe <named curve>
10590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010591 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10592 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010593
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010594ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10596 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10597 client's certificate.
10598
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010599ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10601 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10602 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10603 error is ignored.
10604
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010605ca-sign-file <cafile>
10606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10607 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10608 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10609 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10610 'generate-certificates' for details.
10611
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010612ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010613 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10614 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10615 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10616 'generate-certificates' for details.
10617
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010618ciphers <ciphers>
10619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10620 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010621 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010622 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10623 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010624 Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list of suitable
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010625 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10626 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10627 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010628
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010629crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10631 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10632 to verify client's certificate.
10633
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010634crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10636 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10637 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10638 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10639 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10640 file.
10641
10642 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10643 are loaded.
10644
10645 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010646 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010647 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10648 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10649 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10650 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10652 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010653 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010654
10655 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10656 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10657 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10658 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010659 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10660 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010661
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010662 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010663
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010664 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010665 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010666 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10667 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010668 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10669 clients).
10670
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010671 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10672 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10673 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10674 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10675 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10676 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10677 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10678 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10679 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10680 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10681 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10682 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10683 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10684
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010685 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10686 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10687 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10688 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10689 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10690
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010691 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10692 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10693 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10694 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010695
10696 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10697 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10698 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10699 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10700 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10701 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10702 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10703 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10704 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10705
10706 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10707
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010708 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010709 a cert bundle.
10710
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010711 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010712 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10713 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10714 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10715 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10716 provide multi-cert support.
10717
10718 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10719
10720 Filename | CN | SAN
10721 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10722 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010723 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010724 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10725 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10726
10727 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10728 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10729 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10730 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010731 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10732 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10733 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010734
10735 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10736 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10737
10738 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10739 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10740 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10741
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010742crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010743 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010745 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010746 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010747
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010748crt-list <file>
10749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010750 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10751 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010752
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010753 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10754
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010755 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10756 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010757 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010758 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010759
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010760 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10761 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10762 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10763 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10764 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10765 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10766 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10767 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010768
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010769 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010770 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010771 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10772 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10773 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010774
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010775 crt-list file example:
10776 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010777 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010778 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010779 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010781defer-accept
10782 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10783 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10784 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010786 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10787 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10788 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10789 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10790 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10791 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10792 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10793
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010794expose-fd listeners
10795 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10796 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010797 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10798 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010799 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010800
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010801force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010802 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010803 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010804 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010805 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010806
10807force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010809 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010810 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010811
10812force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010813 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010814 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010815 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010816
10817force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010818 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010819 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010820 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010821
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010822force-tlsv13
10823 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10824 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010825 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010826
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010827generate-certificates
10828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10829 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10830 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10831 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10832 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10833 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10834 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10835 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10836 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10837 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10838 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10839
10840 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10841 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010842 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010843 certificate is used many times.
10844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845gid <gid>
10846 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10847 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10848 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10849 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10850 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10851
10852group <group>
10853 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10854 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10855 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10856 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10857 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10858
10859id <id>
10860 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10861 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10862 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10863 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10864
10865interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010866 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10867 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10868 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10869 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10870 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10871 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010872 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
10873 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
10874 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
10875 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
10876 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
10877 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010879level <level>
10880 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10881 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10882 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010883 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010884 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10885 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10886 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010887 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010888 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010890 all counters).
10891
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010892severity-output <format>
10893 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10894 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10895 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10896 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10897 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10898 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10899 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10900 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10901 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10902 rfc5424 convention.
10903
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010904maxconn <maxconn>
10905 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10906 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10907 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10908 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10909 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10910 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10911 eat all memory.
10912
10913mode <mode>
10914 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10915 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10916 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10917 UNIX sockets.
10918
10919mss <maxseg>
10920 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10921 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10922 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10923 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10924 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10925 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10926 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10927 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10928 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10929 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10930 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10931
10932name <name>
10933 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10934 page.
10935
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010936namespace <name>
10937 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10938 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10939 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10940 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10941
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010942nice <nice>
10943 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10944 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10945 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10946 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10947 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10948 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10949 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10950 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10951 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10952 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10953 one for an RDP socket.
10954
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010955no-ca-names
10956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10957 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10958
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010959no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010960 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010962 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010963 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010964 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10965 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010966
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010967no-tls-tickets
10968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10969 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10970 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010971 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10972 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010973
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010974no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010976 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010977 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010978 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010979 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10980 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010982no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010984 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010985 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010986 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010987 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10988 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010989
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010990no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010992 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010993 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010994 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010995 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10996 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010997
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010998no-tlsv13
10999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11000 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11001 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11002 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011003 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11004 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011005
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011006npn <protocols>
11007 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11008 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11009 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11010 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011011 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011012 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11013 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11014 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11015 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11016 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011017
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011018prefer-client-ciphers
11019 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11020 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11021 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011022 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11023 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11024 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011025
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011026process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11027 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11028 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011030 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11031 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11032 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11033 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011034 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011035 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11036 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11037 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11038
11039 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11040
11041 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11042 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11043 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11044 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11045 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11046 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11047 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11048 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011049
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011050proto <name>
11051 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11052 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11053 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11054 in haproxy -vv.
11055 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11056 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
11057 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifing "proto
11058 h2" on the bind line.
11059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011060ssl
11061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011062 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011063 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11064 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011065 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11066 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011067
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011068ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11069 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11070 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11071 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11072
11073ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11074 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11075 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11076 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11077
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011078strict-sni
11079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11080 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11081 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11082 See the "crt" option for more information.
11083
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011084tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011085 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011086 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11087 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011089 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11090 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11091 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11092 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11093 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11094 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11095 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11096
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011097tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011098 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011099 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11100 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11101 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11102 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11103 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11104 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11105 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011106 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11107 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11108 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011109
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011110tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11111 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
11112 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
11113 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
11114 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
11115 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
11116 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
11117 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
11118 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
11119 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11120 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11121
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011122transparent
11123 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11124 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11125 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11126 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11127 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11128 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11129 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11130 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11131 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11132 so check for support with your vendor.
11133
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011134v4v6
11135 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11136 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11137 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11138 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011139 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011140
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011141v6only
11142 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11143 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11144 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011145 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11146 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148uid <uid>
11149 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11150 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11151 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11152 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11153 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11154
11155user <user>
11156 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11157 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11158 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11159 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11160 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11161
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011162verify [none|optional|required]
11163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11164 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11165 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11166 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11167 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011168 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11169 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11170 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11171 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011172
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200111735.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011174------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011175
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011176The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11177which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11178arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11179settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11180after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11181Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11182address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011184 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011185 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011186
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011187Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11188keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011190The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011191
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011192addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011193 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011194 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11195 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11196 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11197 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11198 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011199
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011200agent-check
11201 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011202 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11203 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11204 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11205 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011206
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011207 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011208 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011209 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11210 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11211 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011213 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11214 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11215 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11216 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11217 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011218
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011219 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011221
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011222 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11223 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11224 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011225
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011226 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11227 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11228 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011229
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011230 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11231 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11232 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11233 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11234 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011236 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011237
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011238 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11239 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011240
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011241 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11242 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11243 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11244 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11245 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11246 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11247 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11248 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11249 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011250
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011251 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11252 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011253 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11254 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11255 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011256 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011257
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011258 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011259 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011260
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011261agent-send <string>
11262 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11263 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11264 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11265 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11266 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11267
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011268agent-inter <delay>
11269 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11270 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11271
11272 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11273 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11274 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11275 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11276 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11277 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11278 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11279 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11280 of backends use the same servers.
11281
11282 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11283
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011284agent-addr <addr>
11285 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11286
11287 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11288 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11289 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11290 hostname, it will be resolved.
11291
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011292agent-port <port>
11293 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11294
11295 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011297backup
11298 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11299 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11300 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11301 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011302 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11303 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011304
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011305ca-file <cafile>
11306 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11307 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11308 server's certificate.
11309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011310check
11311 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011312 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11313 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11314 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11315 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11316 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11317 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11318 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011319 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11320 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011321 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11322 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011323
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011324check-send-proxy
11325 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11326 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11327 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11328 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11329 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11330 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11331 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11332
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011333check-sni
11334 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11335 over SSL.
11336
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011337check-ssl
11338 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11339 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11340 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11341 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011342 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011343 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11344 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011345 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011346 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11347 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011348
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011349ciphers <ciphers>
11350 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011351 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011352 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11353 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11354 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11355 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11356 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11357 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011359cookie <value>
11360 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11361 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11362 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11363 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11364 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11365 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11366 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11367
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011368crl-file <crlfile>
11369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11370 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11371 to verify server's certificate.
11372
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011373crt <cert>
11374 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11375 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11376 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11377 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11378 certificate request.
11379
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011380disabled
11381 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11382 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11383 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11384 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11385 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011386 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011387
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011388enabled
11389 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11390 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11391 default value.
11392 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11393 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011395error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011396 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11397 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11398 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011400 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011402fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011403 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11404 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11405 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11406
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011407force-sslv3
11408 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11409 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011410 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011411 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011412
11413force-tlsv10
11414 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011415 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011416 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011417
11418force-tlsv11
11419 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011420 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011421 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011422
11423force-tlsv12
11424 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011425 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011426 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011427
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011428force-tlsv13
11429 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11430 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011431 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011433id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011434 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11435 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11436 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011437
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011438init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11439 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11440 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011441 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011442 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11443 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11444 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11445 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11446 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11447 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11448 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11449 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11450 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011451 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011452 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11453 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11454 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11455 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11456 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11457 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011458 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011459
11460 Example:
11461 defaults
11462 # never fail on address resolution
11463 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011465inter <delay>
11466fastinter <delay>
11467downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011468 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11469 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11470 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11471 between checks depending on the server state :
11472
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011473 Server state | Interval used
11474 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11475 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11476 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11477 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11478 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11479 or yet unchecked. |
11480 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11481 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11482 | "inter" otherwise.
11483 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011485 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11486 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11487 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11488 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011489 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11490 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11491 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11492 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11493 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011495maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011496 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11497 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11498 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11499 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11500 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11501 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11502 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11503 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11504
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011505maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011506 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11507 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11508 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11509 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11510 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11511 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11512 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011514minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011515 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11516 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11517 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11518 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11519 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11520 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011521 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011522 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011523
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011524namespace <name>
11525 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11526 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11527 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11528 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11529
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011530no-agent-check
11531 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11532 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11533 default value.
11534 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11535 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11536
11537no-backup
11538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11540 default value.
11541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11542 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11543
11544no-check
11545 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11546 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11547 default value.
11548 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11549 "default-server" "check" setting.
11550
11551no-check-ssl
11552 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11553 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11554 default value.
11555 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11556 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11557
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011558no-send-proxy
11559 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11560 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11561 default value.
11562 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11563 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11564
11565no-send-proxy-v2
11566 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11567 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11568 default value.
11569 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11570 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11571
11572no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11573 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11574 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11575 default value.
11576 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11577 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11578
11579no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11582 default value.
11583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11584 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11585
11586no-ssl
11587 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11588 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11589 default value.
11590 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11591 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11592
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011593no-ssl-reuse
11594 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11595 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11596 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11597 and for paranoid users.
11598
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011599no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011600 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11601 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011602 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011603
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011604 Supported in default-server: No
11605
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011606no-tls-tickets
11607 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11608 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11609 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011610 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11611 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011612 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011613
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011614no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011615 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011616 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11617 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011618 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11619 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011620 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011621
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011622 Supported in default-server: No
11623
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011624no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011625 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011626 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11627 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011628 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11629 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011630 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011631
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011632 Supported in default-server: No
11633
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011634no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011635 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011636 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11637 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011638 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11639 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011640 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011641
11642 Supported in default-server: No
11643
11644no-tlsv13
11645 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11646 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11647 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11648 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11649 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011650 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011651
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011652 Supported in default-server: No
11653
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011654no-verifyhost
11655 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11656 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11657 default value.
11658 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11659 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011660
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011661non-stick
11662 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11663 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11664 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011666observe <mode>
11667 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11668 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11669 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11670 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11671 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11672 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011673 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011674
11675 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011677on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011678 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11679 Currently, four modes are available:
11680 - fastinter: force fastinter
11681 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11682 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11683 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11684 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11685
11686 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11687
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011688on-marked-down <action>
11689 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11690 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011691 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11692 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11693 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11694 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11695 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11696 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11697 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11698 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011699
11700 Actions are disabled by default
11701
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011702on-marked-up <action>
11703 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11704 Currently one action is available:
11705 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11706 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11707 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11708 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11710 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011711 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11712 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11713
11714 Actions are disabled by default
11715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011716port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011717 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11718 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11719 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11720 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11721 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11722 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11723
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011724proto <name>
11725
11726 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11727 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11728 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11729 reported in haproxy -vv.
11730 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11731 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011733redir <prefix>
11734 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11735 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11736 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11737 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11738 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11739 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11740 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11741 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011742 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011743 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011744 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11745 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11746 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11747 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11748
11749 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011751rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11753 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11754 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11755
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011756resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11757 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11758 server.
11759
11760 Available options:
11761
11762 * allow-dup-ip
11763 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11764 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11765 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11766 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11767 For such case, simply enable this option.
11768 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11769
11770 * prevent-dup-ip
11771 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11772 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11773 same fqdn.
11774 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11775
11776 Example:
11777 backend b_myapp
11778 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
11779 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11780 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
11781
11782 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
11783 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
11784 it
11785 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
11786 different address
11787
11788 Default value: not set
11789
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011790resolve-prefer <family>
11791 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11792 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11793 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11794 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11795
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011796 Default value: ipv6
11797
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011798 Example:
11799
11800 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011801
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011802resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11803 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11804 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011805 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011806 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11807 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011808 configured network, another address is selected.
11809
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011810 Example:
11811
11812 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011813
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011814resolvers <id>
11815 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11816 hostname.
11817
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011818 Example:
11819
11820 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011821
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011822 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011823
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011824send-proxy
11825 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11826 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11827 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11828 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011829 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11830 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11831 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11832 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11833 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11834 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11835 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11836 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11837 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11838 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011839 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11840 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011841
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011842send-proxy-v2
11843 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11844 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11845 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11846 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011847 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11848 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11849 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11850 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011851
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011852proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
11853 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
11854 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010011855 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
11856 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010011857 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
11858 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010011859 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010011860
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011861send-proxy-v2-ssl
11862 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11863 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11864 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11865 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11866 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11867 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11868 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011869 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11870 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011871
11872send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11873 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11874 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11875 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11876 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11877 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11878 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11879 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11880 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011881 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
11882 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011884slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11886 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11887 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11888 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11889 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11890 parameters :
11891
11892 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11893 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11894
11895 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11896 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11897 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11898 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11899
11900 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11901 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11902 seen as failed.
11903
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011904sni <expression>
11905 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11906 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11907 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11908 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011909 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11910 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011911 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11912 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011913
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011914source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011915source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011916source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011917 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11918 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11919 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11920 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11921
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011922 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11923 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11924 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11925 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11926 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11927 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11928 server.
11929
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011930 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11931 specifying the source address without port(s).
11932
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011933ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011934 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11935 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11936 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11937 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11938 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11939 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011940 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11941 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011942
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011943ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11944 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11945 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11946 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11947
11948ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11949 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11950 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11951 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11952
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011953ssl-reuse
11954 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11955 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11956 default value.
11957 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11958 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11959
11960stick
11961 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11962 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11963 default value.
11964 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11965 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011966
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011967tcp-ut <delay>
11968 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11969 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11970 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011971 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011972 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11973 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11974 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11975 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11976 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11977 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11978 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11979 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11980 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011982track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011983 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11984 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11985 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11986 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011987 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11988
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011989tls-tickets
11990 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11991 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11992 default value.
11993 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11994 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011995
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011996verify [none|required]
11997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011998 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011999 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12000 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012002 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12003 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12004 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12005 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12006 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12007 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12008 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12009 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012010
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012011verifyhost <hostname>
12012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012013 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12014 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12015 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12016 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12017 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12018 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12019 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12020 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012022weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012023 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12024 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12025 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012026 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12027 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12028 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12029 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12030 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12031 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012032
12033
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12035-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012036
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012037HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12038using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12039configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012040This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12041can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12042workload.
12043This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12044resolution at run time.
12045Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12046carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12047
12048
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120495.3.1. Global overview
12050----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012051
12052As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12053different steps of the process life:
12054
12055 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12056 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12057 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12058
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012059 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12060 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012061
12062A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12063 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12064 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12065 resolution to know this new IP.
12066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012067When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012068HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012069SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12070from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12071will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12072will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012074A few things important to notice:
12075 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12076 first valid response.
12077
12078 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12079 servers return an error.
12080
12081
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200120825.3.2. The resolvers section
12083----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012084
12085This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012086HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12087contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012088
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012089When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12090uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12091is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12092answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12093
12094When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012095used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012096
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012097 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12098 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12099 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012100
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012101 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12102 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012103
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012104 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12105 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12106 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012107
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012108For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12109following scenarios are possible:
12110
12111 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12112 ignored
12113
12114 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12115 applied
12116
12117 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12118 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12119
12120 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12121 retries the query with a new type
12122
12123 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12124 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012125
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012126As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12127a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012128<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012129
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012131resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012132 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012133
12134A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12135
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012136accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012137 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012138 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012139 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12140 by RFC 6891)
12141
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012142 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12143
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012144nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12145 DNS server description:
12146 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12147 <ip> : IP address of the server
12148 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12149
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012150parse-resolv-conf
12151 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12152 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12153 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12154
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012155hold <status> <period>
12156 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12157 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012158 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012159 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012160 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12161 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12162 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12163
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012164 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012165
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012166resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012167 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12168 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12169 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12170
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012171resolve_retries <nb>
12172 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12173 giving up.
12174 Default value: 3
12175
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012176 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12177 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12178 type.
12179
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012180timeout <event> <time>
12181 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12182 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12183 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012184 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12185 other time applied.
12186 Default value: 1s
12187 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12188 have been received.
12189 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012190 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12191 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12192
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012193 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012194
12195 resolvers mydns
12196 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12197 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012198 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012199 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012200 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012201 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012202 hold other 30s
12203 hold refused 30s
12204 hold nx 30s
12205 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012206 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012207 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012208
12209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122106. HTTP header manipulation
12211---------------------------
12212
12213In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12214response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12215request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12216which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012217against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012219If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12220to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12221but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12222HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12223stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12224because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12225a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12226still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012228This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12229in section 4.2 :
12230
12231 - reqadd <string>
12232 - reqallow <search>
12233 - reqiallow <search>
12234 - reqdel <search>
12235 - reqidel <search>
12236 - reqdeny <search>
12237 - reqideny <search>
12238 - reqpass <search>
12239 - reqipass <search>
12240 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12241 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12242 - reqtarpit <search>
12243 - reqitarpit <search>
12244 - rspadd <string>
12245 - rspdel <search>
12246 - rspidel <search>
12247 - rspdeny <search>
12248 - rspideny <search>
12249 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12250 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12251
12252With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12253is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12254parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12255prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12256Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12257
12258 \t for a tab
12259 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12260 \n for a new line (LF)
12261 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12262 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12263 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12264 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12265 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12266
12267The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12268portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12269above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12270regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
122719 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12272is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12273
12274The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12275after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12276
12277Notes related to these keywords :
12278---------------------------------
12279 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12280 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12281 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12282
12283 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12284 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12285 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12286
12287 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12288 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12289 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12290 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12291 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12292
12293 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12294 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12295 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12296 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12297 useless headers before adding new ones.
12298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012299 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012300 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12301
12302 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12303 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12304 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12305
12306 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12307 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012308 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012309
12310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123117. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12312----------------------------------
12313
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012314HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012315client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12316The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12317these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12318but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12319data called patterns.
12320
12321
123227.1. ACL basics
12323---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012324
12325The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12326content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12327from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12328simple :
12329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012330 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012331 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012332 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12333 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012335The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12336adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012337
12338In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012340 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012341
12342This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12343Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12344and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012345an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12346conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12347as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12348are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012349
12350ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12351'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12352which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12353
12354There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12355performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12358specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12359this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012360methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12361ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012362
12363Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12364 - boolean
12365 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12366 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12367 - string
12368 - data block
12369
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012370Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12371converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12372would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12373The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12374which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12375
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012376Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12377keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12378fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12379which are summarized in the table below :
12380
12381 +---------------------+-----------------+
12382 | Sample or converter | Default |
12383 | output type | matching method |
12384 +---------------------+-----------------+
12385 | boolean | bool |
12386 +---------------------+-----------------+
12387 | integer | int |
12388 +---------------------+-----------------+
12389 | ip | ip |
12390 +---------------------+-----------------+
12391 | string | str |
12392 +---------------------+-----------------+
12393 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12394 +---------------------+-----------------+
12395
12396Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12397matching method, see below.
12398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012399The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12400 - boolean
12401 - integer or integer range
12402 - IP address / network
12403 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12404 - regular expression
12405 - hex block
12406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012407The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12408
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012409 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12410 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012411 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012412 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012413 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012414 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012415 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012417The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12418read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12419if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12420lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12421will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12422beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12423a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12424lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12425exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12426
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012427The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12428parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12429ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12430a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12431check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12432
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012433The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12434socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12435file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12438loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12439
12440 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12441
12442In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12443the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12444case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12445as well.
12446
12447The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12448sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12449do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12450methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12451is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012453followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12454default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12455that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12456string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12457
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012458The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12459By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12460string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12461resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12462server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12463waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12464flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12465function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012467There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12468sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12469be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012470
12471 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12472 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012473 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12474 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12475 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12476 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012477
12478 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12479 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012481
12482 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012483 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012484
12485 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012486 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012487
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012488 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012489 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12490
12491 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12492 binary or string samples.
12493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012494 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12495 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012497 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12498 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12499 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12502 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12505 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12508 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012510 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12511 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012512 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12515 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12516 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012517
12518For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12519request, it is possible to do :
12520
12521 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12522
12523In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12524buffer, one would use the following acl :
12525
12526 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12527
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012528On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12529possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12530
12531 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012533All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12534criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12535method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12536to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12537criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12538the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012540If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012541the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12542For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012544 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12545 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12546 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12547 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012548
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012549
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012550The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12551types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12552combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12553brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12554default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012556 +-------------------------------------------------+
12557 | Input sample type |
12558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012559 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12561 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012563 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012565 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012567 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012569 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012571 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012573 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012575 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012577 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012579 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012581 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012583 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12585 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12586 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012587
12588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125897.1.1. Matching booleans
12590------------------------
12591
12592In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12593Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12594When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12595that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12596
12597Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12598return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12599"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126027.1.2. Matching integers
12603------------------------
12604
12605Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12606enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12607to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12608
12609Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12610matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12611lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012612
12613For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12614unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12615representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12616
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012617As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12618two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12619instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12620ranges and operators.
12621
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012622For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012623operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12624Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12625of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012627Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012628
12629 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12630 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12631 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12632 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12633 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012635For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012636
12637 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12638
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012639This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12640
12641 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126447.1.3. Matching strings
12645-----------------------
12646
12647String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12648different forms :
12649
12650 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012651 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652
12653 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012654 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655
12656 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12657 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12658
12659 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12660 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12661
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012662 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012663 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12664 matches.
12665
12666 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12667 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12668 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012669
12670String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12671exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12672characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12673string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12674to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012675before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012676
12677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12679---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012680
12681Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12682they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12683possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12684passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12685the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012686the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12687match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012688
12689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126907.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12691-------------------------------------
12692
12693It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12694not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12695a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12696to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12697digits may be used upper or lower case.
12698
12699Example :
12700 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12701 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12702
12703
127047.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12705---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012706
12707IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12708netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12709within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012710host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012711difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12712at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12713does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12714parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012715
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012716The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12717abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12718
12719 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12720 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12721 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12722 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12723 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12724 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12725 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12726 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12727
12728Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12729192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12730
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012731IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12732Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12733trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12734IPv6 patterns.
12735
12736HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12737following situations :
12738 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12739 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12740 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12741 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12742 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12743 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12744 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12745 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12746 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12747 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749
127507.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12751----------------------------------
12752
12753Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12754combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12755
12756 - AND (implicit)
12757 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12758 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012760A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12765indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12768"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12769requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12770is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12771
12772 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012773 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12774 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12775 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012776
12777To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12778and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12779
12780 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12781 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12782 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12783 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012786 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12787 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12788 use_backend www if host_www
12789
12790It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12791expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12792be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12793the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12794
12795 The following rule :
12796
12797 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012798 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799
12800 Can also be written that way :
12801
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012802 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803
12804It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12805to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12806simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12807sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12808good use is the following :
12809
12810 With named ACLs :
12811
12812 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12813 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12814 monitor fail if site_dead
12815
12816 With anonymous ACLs :
12817
12818 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12819
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012820See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12821keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822
12823
128247.3. Fetching samples
12825---------------------
12826
12827Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12828against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12829sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12830ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12831of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12832available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12833
12834This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12835Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12836compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12837deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12838
12839The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12840matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12841method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12842indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12843
12844As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12845when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12846mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12847the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12848ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12849
12850Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12851multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12852when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012853incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12854are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12856all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12857
12858Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12859 - name
12860 - name(arg1)
12861 - name(arg1,arg2)
12862
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012863
128647.3.1. Converters
12865-----------------
12866
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012867Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12868of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12869is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12870was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012871has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012872unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12873
12874These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12875sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12876the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012877support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012879A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12880support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12881supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12882(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12883bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001288751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12888 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12889 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12890 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12891 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12892 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12893
12894 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012895 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
12896 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000012897 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12898 frontend http-in
12899 bind *:8081
12900 default_backend servers
12901 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12902 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12903
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012904add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012905 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012906 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012907 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12908 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012909 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012910 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12911 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12912 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12913 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012914 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012915 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012916
12917and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012918 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012919 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012920 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12921 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012922 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012923 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12924 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12925 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12926 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012927 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012928 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012929
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012930b64dec
12931 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12932 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12933
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012934base64
12935 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012936 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012937 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012939bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012940 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012941 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012942 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012943 presence of a flag).
12944
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012945bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12946 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12947 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012948 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012949
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010012950concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
12951 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
12952 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
12953 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
12954 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
12955 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
12956 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
12957 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
12958 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
12959 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
12960 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
12961 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
12962 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
12963 delimitors.
12964
12965 Example:
12966 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
12967 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
12968 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
12969 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
12970
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012971cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012972 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12973 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012974
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012975crc32([<avalanche>])
12976 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12977 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12978 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12979 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12980 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12981 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12982 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12983 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12984 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12985 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010012986 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
12987
12988crc32c([<avalanche>])
12989 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
12990 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12991 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12992 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
12993 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
12994 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
12995 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12996 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012997
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012998da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012999 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13000 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13001 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13002 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013003 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013004 configuration language.
13005
13006 Example:
13007 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013008 bind *:8881
13009 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013010 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013011
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013012debug
13013 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13014 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13015 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13016
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013017div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013018 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13019 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013020 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013021 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13022 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013023 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013024 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13025 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13026 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13027 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013028 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013029 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013030
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013031djb2([<avalanche>])
13032 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13033 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13034 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13035 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13036 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13037 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13038 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013039 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13040 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013041
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013042even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013043 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013044 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13045
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013046field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13047 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13048 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13049 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13050 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13051 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13052 fields.
13053
13054 Example :
13055 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13056 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13057 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13058 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13059 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013061hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013062 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013063 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013064 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013065 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013066
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013067hex2i
13068 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13069 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13070
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013071http_date([<offset>])
13072 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13073 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13074 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13075 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13076 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13077 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013078
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013079in_table(<table>)
13080 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13081 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13082 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013084 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13085
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013086ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13087 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013088 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013089 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13090 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13091 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13092 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13093 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013094
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013095json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013096 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013097 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013098 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013099 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13100 of errors:
13101 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13102 bytes, ...)
13103 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13104 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13105
13106 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13107 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13108 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13109 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13110 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13111 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013112 - "ascii" : never fails;
13113 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13114 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013115 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013116 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013117 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13118 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13119
13120 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013121 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013122
13123 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013124 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013125 capture request header user-agent len 150
13126 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013127
13128 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13129 GET / HTTP/1.0
13130 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13131
13132 Output log:
13133 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013135language(<value>[,<default>])
13136 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13137 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13138 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13139 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13140 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13141 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13142 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13143 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13144 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013145 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013146 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13147 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013148
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013149 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013150
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013151 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13152 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013153
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013154 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13155 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13156 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13157 use_backend spanish if es
13158 use_backend french if fr
13159 use_backend english if en
13160 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013161
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013162length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013163 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13164 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13165 type. The result is of type integer.
13166
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013167lower
13168 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13169 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13170 type. The result is of type string.
13171
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013172ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13173 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13174 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13175 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13176 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13177 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13178 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13179
13180 Example :
13181
13182 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013183 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013184 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13185
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013186map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13187map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13188map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13189 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13190 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13191 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13192 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13193 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13194 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13195 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13196 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013197
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013198 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13199 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13200 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013201
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013202 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013203 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013204
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013205 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13206 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13207 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13208 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013209 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13210 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013211 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13212 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13213 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13214 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13215 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13216 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13217 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13218 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013219 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13220 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13221 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013222 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13223 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13224 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13225 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13226 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013227
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013228 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13229 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13230 the corresponding match text.
13231
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013232 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13233 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13234 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13235 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13236 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013237
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013238 Example :
13239
13240 # this is a comment and is ignored
13241 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13242 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13243 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13244 | | | `---------- value
13245 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13246 | `---------------------------- key
13247 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13248
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013249mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013250 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13251 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013252 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013253 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013254 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013255 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13256 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13257 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13258 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013260 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013261
13262mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013263 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013264 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13265 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013266 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013267 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13270 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013274 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013275
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013276nbsrv
13277 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13278 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13279 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13280 map lookup.
13281
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013282neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013283 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13284 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13285 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13286 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013287
13288not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013289 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013290 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013291 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013292 absence of a flag).
13293
13294odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013295 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013296 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13297
13298or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013299 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013300 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013301 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13302 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13307 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013308 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013309 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013310
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013311regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013312 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13313 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13314 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13315 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13316 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13317 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13318 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13319 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13320 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13321 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013322 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13323 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13324 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13325 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013326
13327 Example :
13328
13329 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13330 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13331 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13332 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13333
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013334capture-req(<id>)
13335 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13336 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13337
13338 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013339 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13340 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013341
13342capture-res(<id>)
13343 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13344 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13345
13346 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013347 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13348 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013349
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013350sdbm([<avalanche>])
13351 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13352 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13353 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13354 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13355 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13356 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13357 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013358 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13359 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013360
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013361set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013362 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13363 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13364 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013368 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013373
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013374sha1
13375 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13376 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13377
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013378strcmp(<var>)
13379 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13380 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13381 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13382 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13383 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13384 shorter).
13385
13386 Example :
13387
13388 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13389 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13390 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13391
13392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013393sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013394 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13395 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013396 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013397 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13398 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013399 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013400 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13401 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013402 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013403 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13404 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013405 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013406 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013407
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013408table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13409 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13410 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13411 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13412 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13413 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13414 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13415
13416
13417table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13420 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13421 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13422 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13423 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13424
13425table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013428 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013429 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13430 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13431
13432table_conn_cur(<table>)
13433 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13434 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13435 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13436 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13437 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13438
13439table_conn_rate(<table>)
13440 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13441 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13442 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13443 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13444 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13445
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013446table_gpt0(<table>)
13447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13449 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13450 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13451 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13452
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013453table_gpc0(<table>)
13454 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13455 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13456 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13457 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13458 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13459
13460table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13461 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13462 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13463 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13464 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13465 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13466 sample fetch keyword.
13467
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013468table_gpc1(<table>)
13469 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13470 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13471 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13472 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13473 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13474
13475table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13478 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13479 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13480 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13481 sample fetch keyword.
13482
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013483table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013487 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13488 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13489
13490table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13491 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13492 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13493 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13494 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13495 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13496 keyword.
13497
13498table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13499 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13500 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013501 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013502 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13503 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13504
13505table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13506 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13507 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13508 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13509 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13510 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13511 keyword.
13512
13513table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13514 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13515 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013516 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013517 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13518 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13519 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13520 keyword.
13521
13522table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13523 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13524 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013525 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013526 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13527 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13528 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13529 keyword.
13530
13531table_server_id(<table>)
13532 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13533 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13534 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13535 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13536 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13537 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13538
13539table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013543 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13544 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13545 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13546 keyword.
13547
13548table_sess_rate(<table>)
13549 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13550 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13551 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13552 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13553 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13554 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13555 keyword.
13556
13557table_trackers(<table>)
13558 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13559 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13560 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13561 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13562 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13563 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13564 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13565 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13566 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13567 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13568
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013569upper
13570 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13571 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13572 type. The result is of type string.
13573
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013574url_dec
13575 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13576 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13577
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013578unset-var(<var name>)
13579 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13580 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13581 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13582 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13583 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13584 response),
13585 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13586 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13587 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13588 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13589
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013590utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13591 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13592 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13593 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13594 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13595 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13596 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13597
13598 Example :
13599
13600 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013601 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013602 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13603
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013604word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13605 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13606 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13607 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13608 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13609 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13610
13611 Example :
13612 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13613 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13614 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13615 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13616 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013617
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013618wt6([<avalanche>])
13619 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13620 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13621 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13622 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13623 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13624 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13625 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013626 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13627 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013628
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013629xor(<value>)
13630 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013631 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013632 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013633 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013634 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013635 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13636 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013637 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013638 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13639 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013640 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013641 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013642
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013643xxh32([<seed>])
13644 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13645 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13646 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13647 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13648 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13649 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13650 as cryptographically secure.
13651
13652xxh64([<seed>])
13653 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13654 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13655 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13656 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13657 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13658 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13659 as cryptographically secure.
13660
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136627.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663--------------------------------------------
13664
13665A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13666not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13667"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13668The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13669
13670always_false : boolean
13671 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13672 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13673
13674always_true : boolean
13675 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13676 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13677
13678avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013679 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13681 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13682 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13683 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13684 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13685 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13686 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13687 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13688 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13689 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13690 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13691 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13692 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013695 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13696 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13697 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13698 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013699 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
13700
13701be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
13702 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13703 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
13704 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
13705 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
13706 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013707 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
13708 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040013709
13710 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
13711 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
13712 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13715 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13716 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13717 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13720 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013721
13722 Example :
13723 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13724 backend dynamic
13725 mode http
13726 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13727 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013728
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013729bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013730 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13731 of the string.
13732
13733bool(<bool>) : bool
13734 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13735 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013737connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013739 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013740 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13741 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013742
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013743 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013744 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013745 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13746
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013747 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13748 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013749
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013750 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013751 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013753 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013754 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013756 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013757
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013758 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13759 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013760 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013761 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013762
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013763date([<offset>]) : integer
13764 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13765 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13766 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13767 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013768 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13769
13770 Example :
13771
13772 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13773 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013774
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010013775date_us : integer
13776 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
13777 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
13778 from the same timeval structure.
13779
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013780distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13781 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13782 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13783 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13784 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13785 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13786 list of supported tokens.
13787
13788distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13789 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13790 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13791 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13792 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13793 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13794 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13795 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13796 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13797 supported tokens.
13798
13799 Example :
13800 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13801 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13802 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13803 # send large files to the big farm
13804 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13805
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013806env(<name>) : string
13807 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13808 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13809 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13810 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13811 certain way.
13812
13813 Examples :
13814 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13815 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13816
13817 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13818 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13821 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013822 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13823 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13825 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013826 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13828 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013829
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013830fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13831 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13832 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13833 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13837 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13838 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13839 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13840 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13841 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13842 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13843 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013844
13845 Example :
13846 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13847 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13848 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13849 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13850 frontend mail
13851 bind :25
13852 mode tcp
13853 maxconn 100
13854 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13855 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13856 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13857 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013858
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013859hostname : string
13860 Returns the system hostname.
13861
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013862int(<integer>) : signed integer
13863 Returns a signed integer.
13864
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013865ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13866 Returns an ipv4.
13867
13868ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13869 Returns an ipv6.
13870
13871meth(<method>) : method
13872 Returns a method.
13873
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013874nbproc : integer
13875 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13876 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13877 and debugging purposes.
13878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013879nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13880 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13881 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13882 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013883 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13884 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13885 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013886
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040013887prio_class : integer
13888 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
13889 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
13890 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
13891
13892prio_offset : integer
13893 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
13894 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
13895 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
13896 set-priority-offset".
13897
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013898proc : integer
13899 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13900 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13901 debugging purposes.
13902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013904 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13905 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13906 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013907 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13908 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13909 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13910 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13911 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13912
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013913rand([<range>]) : integer
13914 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13915 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13916 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13917 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13918 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013920srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13922 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13923 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13924 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13925 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040013926 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
13927 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
13928
13929srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13930 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
13931 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
13932 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13933 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
13934 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
13935 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
13936 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
13937
13938 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
13939 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013940
13941srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13942 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13943 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13944 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013945 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13947 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13948 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13949
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013950srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13951 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13952 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13953 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13954 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13955 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13956 fetch methods.
13957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013958srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13959 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13960 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013961 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13963 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013964 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965 overloading servers).
13966
13967 Example :
13968 # Redirect to a separate back
13969 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13970 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13971 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13972
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013973stopping : boolean
13974 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13975 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13976 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13977
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013978str(<string>) : string
13979 Returns a string.
13980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13982 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13983 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13984
13985table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13986 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13987 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13988 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13989
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013990thread : integer
13991 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13992 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13993 and debugging purposes.
13994
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013995var(<var-name>) : undefined
13996 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013997 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13998 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013999 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014000 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14001 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014002 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014003 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14004 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014006 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009----------------------------------
14010
14011The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14012closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14013methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14014sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14015TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014016the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14017counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014018"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14019used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14020can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14021Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14022table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14023tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14024currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025
14026be_id : integer
14027 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14028 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14029
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014030be_name : string
14031 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14032 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034dst : ip
14035 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14036 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14037 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14038 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
14039 RFC 4291.
14040
14041dst_conn : integer
14042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14043 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14044 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14045 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14046 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14047 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14048 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14049 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014050
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014051dst_is_local : boolean
14052 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14053 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14054 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14055 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014057 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14058 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14059 it only once per connection.
14060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061dst_port : integer
14062 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14063 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14064 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14065 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14066 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14067 an HTTP header.
14068
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014069fc_http_major : integer
14070 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14071 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14072 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14073
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014074fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14075 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14076 header.
14077
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014078fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14079 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14080 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14081 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14082 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14083 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14084 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14085
14086fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14087 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14088 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14089 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14090 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14091 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14092 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14093
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014094fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14095 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14096 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14097 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14098 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14099
14100fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14101 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14102 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14103 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14104 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14105
14106fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14107 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14108 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14109 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14110 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14111
14112fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14113 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14114 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14115 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14116 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14117
14118fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14119 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14120 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14121 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14122 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14123
14124fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14125 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14126 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14127 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14128 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14129
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014130fe_defbe : string
14131 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14132 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134fe_id : integer
14135 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014136 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14138
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014139fe_name : string
14140 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14141 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14142 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14143
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014144sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014145sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14146sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14147sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014148 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14149 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14150 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14151
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014152sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014153sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14154sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14155sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014156 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14157 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14158 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14159
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014160sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014161sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14162sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14163sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014164 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14165 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014166 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14167 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14168 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014169
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014170 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014171 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14172 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014173 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14174 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14175 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014176 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14177 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14178
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014179sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14180sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14181sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14182sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14183 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14184 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14185 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14186 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14187 when a first ACL was verified.
14188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014189sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014190sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14191sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14192sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014193 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014194 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14195
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014196sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014197sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14198sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14199sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014200 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14201 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14202 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14203
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014204sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014205sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14206sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14207sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014208 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14209 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14210 See also src_conn_rate.
14211
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014212sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014213sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14214sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14215sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014216 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014217 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014218
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014219sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14220sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14221sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14222sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14223 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14224 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14225
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014226sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14227sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14228sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14229sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14230 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14231 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014233sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014234sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14235sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14236sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014237 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14238 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14239 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014240 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14241 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14242 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014243
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014244sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14245sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14246sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14247sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14248 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14249 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14250 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14251 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14252 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14253 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14254
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014255sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014256sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14257sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14258sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014259 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014260 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14261 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014263sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014264sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14265sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14266sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014267 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14268 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14269 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14270 src_http_err_rate.
14271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014272sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014273sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14274sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14275sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014276 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014277 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14278 src_http_req_cnt.
14279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014280sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014281sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14282sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14283sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014284 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14285 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14286 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14287 src_http_req_rate.
14288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014289sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014290sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14291sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14292sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014293 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014294 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14295 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14296 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14297 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014298
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014299 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014300 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14301 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014302 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14303
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014304sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14305sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14306sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14307sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14308 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14309 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14310 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14311 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14312 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14313
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014314sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014315sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14316sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14317sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014318 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14319 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14320 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014321
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014322sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014323sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14324sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14325sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014326 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14327 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14328 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014329
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014330sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014331sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14332sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14333sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014334 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014335 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14336 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14337 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014338 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014339 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014341sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014342sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14343sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14344sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014345 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14346 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14347 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14348 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14349 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014350 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014352sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014353sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14354sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14355sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014356 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14357 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14358 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014360sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014361sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14362sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14363sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014364 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14365 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014366 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014367 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14368 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14370 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14371 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373so_id : integer
14374 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14375 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14376 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014379 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14381 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14382 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014383 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14384 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14385 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14386 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014387
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014388 Example:
14389 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14390 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14393 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14394 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14395 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014396 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14399 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14400 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014401 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014402 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14405 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14406 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14407 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14408 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14409 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14410 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014411
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014412 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014413 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14414 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14415 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14416 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014417 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014418 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14419 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14420
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014421src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14422 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14423 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14424 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14425 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14426 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14427 was verified.
14428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014430 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014431 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014432 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014433 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014435src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014436 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14438 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014439 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14442 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14443 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14444 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014445 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014448 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014450 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014451 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014452
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014453src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14454 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14455 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14456 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14457 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14458
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014459src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14460 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14461 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14462 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14463 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014466 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014467 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014468 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14469 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014470 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14471 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14472 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014473
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014474src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14475 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14476 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14477 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14478 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14479 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14480 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14481 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014484 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014486 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014487 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14491 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14492 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14493 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14494 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014495 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014497src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014498 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14500 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014501 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14504 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14505 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14506 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014507 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014508 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14511 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14512 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14513 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014514 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14516 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014517
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014518 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014519 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014520 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014521 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014522
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014523src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14524 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14525 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14526 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14527 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14528 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14529 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14530
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014531src_is_local : boolean
14532 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14533 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14534 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14535 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014536 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014537 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14538 once per connection.
14539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014541 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14542 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14543 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14544 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14545 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014547src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014548 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14549 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14550 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14551 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14552 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554src_port : integer
14555 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14556 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14557 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14558 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014561 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014562 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14563 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14564 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014565 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14568 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14569 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14570 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14571 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014572 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14575 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14576 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14577 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14578 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14579 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14580 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14581 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14582 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014583
14584 Example :
14585 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14586 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14587 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14588 listen ssh
14589 bind :22
14590 mode tcp
14591 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014592 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014594 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596srv_id : integer
14597 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14598 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14599 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014600
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146017.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14605closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14606when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14607usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014608future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014609
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001461051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14611 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14612 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14613 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14614 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14615 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14616
14617 Example :
14618 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14619 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14620 # the request.
14621 frontend http-in
14622 bind *:8081
14623 default_backend servers
14624 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14625 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14626
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014627ssl_bc : boolean
14628 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14629 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14630 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14631
14632ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14633 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14634 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14635
14636ssl_bc_cipher : string
14637 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14638 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14639
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010014640ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
14641 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14642 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
14643 session or a TLS ticket.
14644
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014645ssl_bc_protocol : string
14646 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14647 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14648
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014649ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014650 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014651 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14652 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014653
14654ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14655 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14656 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14657 if session was reused or not.
14658
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014659ssl_bc_session_key : binary
14660 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
14661 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14662 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14663 BoringSSL.
14664
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014665ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14666 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14667 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014669ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14670 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14671 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14672 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14673 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14674 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014676ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14677 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14678 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14679 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14680 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014681
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014682ssl_c_der : binary
14683 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14684 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14685 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687ssl_c_err : integer
14688 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14689 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14690 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14691 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14692 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14695 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14696 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14697 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14698 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14699 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14700 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14701 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14702 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704ssl_c_key_alg : string
14705 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14706 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14707 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014709ssl_c_notafter : string
14710 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14711 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14712 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714ssl_c_notbefore : string
14715 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14716 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14717 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14720 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14721 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14722 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14723 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14724 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14725 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14726 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14727 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729ssl_c_serial : binary
14730 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14731 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14732 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014734ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14735 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14736 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14737 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014738 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14739 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14740
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014741 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014742 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14745 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14746 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14747 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014749ssl_c_used : boolean
14750 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14751 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753ssl_c_verify : integer
14754 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14755 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14756 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14757 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759ssl_c_version : integer
14760 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14761 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014762
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014763ssl_f_der : binary
14764 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14765 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14766 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14770 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14771 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14772 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014773 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14775 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14776 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778ssl_f_key_alg : string
14779 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14780 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14781 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783ssl_f_notafter : string
14784 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14785 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14786 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788ssl_f_notbefore : string
14789 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14790 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14791 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14794 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14795 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14796 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14797 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14798 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14799 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14800 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14801 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803ssl_f_serial : binary
14804 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14805 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14806 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014807
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014808ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14809 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14810 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14811 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14814 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14815 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14816 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818ssl_f_version : integer
14819 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14820 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14821
14822ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014823 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14824 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14825 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827 Example :
14828 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14829 listen http-https
14830 bind :80
14831 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14832 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14833
14834ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14835 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14836 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14837
14838ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014839 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14841 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14842 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14843 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14844 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14845 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14846 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14847 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849ssl_fc_cipher : string
14850 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14851 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014852
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014853ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14854 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14855 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014856 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014857
14858ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14859 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14860 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014861 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014862
14863ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14864 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14865 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14866 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014867 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014868 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014869
14870ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14871 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14872 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014873 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014876 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14877 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014878 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14879 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14880 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14881 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014882
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014883ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14884 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14885 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14886 wait until the handshake happened.
14887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14889 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014890 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14891 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14892 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14893 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014894
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014895ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014896 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010014897 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
14898 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014901 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14903 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14904 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14905 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14906 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14907 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14908 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910ssl_fc_protocol : string
14911 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14912 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014913
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014914ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014915 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014916 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14917 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14920 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14921 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14922 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14923 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014924
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040014925ssl_fc_session_key : binary
14926 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
14927 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
14928 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
14929 BoringSSL.
14930
14931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932ssl_fc_sni : string
14933 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14934 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14935 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14936 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14937 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14938
14939 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14940 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14941 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014942 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14943 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014945 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14947 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14950 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14951 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014952
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014953
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200149547.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14958sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14959only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14960For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14961be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14962can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14963sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14964for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14965content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014968 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14970 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14973 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014974 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014976
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014977req.hdrs : string
14978 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14979 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14980 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14981 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14982
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014983req.hdrs_bin : binary
14984 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14985 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14986 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14987 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14988 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14989 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14990
14991 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14992
14993 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14994 str: <int:length><bytes>
14995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014996req.len : integer
14997req_len : integer (deprecated)
14998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14999 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15000 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15001 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15002 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15003 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15004 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15005 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15008 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015009 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15010 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15011 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15012 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014 ACL alternatives :
15015 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15018 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15019 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15020 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15021 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023 ACL alternatives :
15024 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015028req.proto_http : boolean
15029req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15030 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15031 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15032 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15033 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15034 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15035 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15036 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038 Example:
15039 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15040 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15041 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015042 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15045rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15046 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15047 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15048 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15049 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15050 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15051 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15052 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15055 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15056 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15057 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15058 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15059 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061 ACL derivatives :
15062 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064 Example :
15065 listen tse-farm
15066 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15067 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15068 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15069 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15070 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15071 persist rdp-cookie
15072 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15073 # This is only useful makes sense if
15074 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15075 stick-table type string size 204800
15076 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15077 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15078 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15081 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15084rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15085 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15086 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15087 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15088 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090 ACL derivatives :
15091 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015092
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015093req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15094 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15095 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015096 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15097 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15098 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15099 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15100 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15103req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15104 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15105 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15106 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15107 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15108 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15109 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15110 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112req.ssl_sni : string
15113req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15114 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15115 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15116 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15117 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15118 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15119 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15120 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15121 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15122 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15123 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15124 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15125 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127 ACL derivatives :
15128 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130 Examples :
15131 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15132 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15133 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15134 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15135 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015136
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015137req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15138 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15139 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15140 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15141 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15142 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15143 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15144 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15145 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15146 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015148req.ssl_ver : integer
15149req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15150 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15151 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15152 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15153 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15154 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15155 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15156 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015157 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160 ACL derivatives :
15161 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015162
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015163res.len : integer
15164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15165 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15166 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15167 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15168 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15169 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15170 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15171 content inspection.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15174 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015175 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15176 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15177 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15178 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15181 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15182 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15183 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15184 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015187
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015188res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15189rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15190 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15191 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15192 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15193 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15194 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15195 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15196 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198wait_end : boolean
15199 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15200 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015201 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15203 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015204 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15206 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208 Examples :
15209 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15210 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15211 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15214 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15215 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15216 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15217 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15218 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15219 tcp-request content reject
15220
15221
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152227.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015223--------------------------------------
15224
15225It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15226This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15227data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15228its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15229HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15230content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15231to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15232more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15233response are indexed.
15234
15235base : string
15236 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15237 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15238 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15239 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15240 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15241 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15242 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15243 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15244
15245 ACL derivatives :
15246 base : exact string match
15247 base_beg : prefix match
15248 base_dir : subdir match
15249 base_dom : domain match
15250 base_end : suffix match
15251 base_len : length match
15252 base_reg : regex match
15253 base_sub : substring match
15254
15255base32 : integer
15256 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15257 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15258 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015259 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15260 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15261 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015262
15263base32+src : binary
15264 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15265 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15266 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15267 per-URL counters.
15268
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015269capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15270 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15271 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15272 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15273
15274capture.req.method : string
15275 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15276 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15277 because it's allocated.
15278
15279capture.req.uri : string
15280 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15281 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15282 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15283 allocated.
15284
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015285capture.req.ver : string
15286 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15287 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15288 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15289
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015290capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15291 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15292 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15293 The first entry is an index of 0.
15294 See also: "capture response header"
15295
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015296capture.res.ver : string
15297 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15298 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15299 persistent flag.
15300
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015301req.body : binary
15302 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15303 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15304 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15305 the first chunk is analyzed.
15306
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015307req.body_param([<name>) : string
15308 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15309 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15310 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15311 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15312 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15313 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15314 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15315 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15316 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15317 given.
15318
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015319req.body_len : integer
15320 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15321 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15322 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15323 "option http-buffer-request".
15324
15325req.body_size : integer
15326 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15327 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15328 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15329 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15330 "option http-buffer-request".
15331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332req.cook([<name>]) : string
15333cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15334 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15335 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15336 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15337 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15338 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15339 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15340 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15341 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15342
15343 ACL derivatives :
15344 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15345 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15346 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15347 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15348 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15349 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15350 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15351 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15354cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15355 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15356 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15359cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15360 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15361 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15362 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15363 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15366 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15367 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15368 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15369 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015370 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015371 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15372 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15373 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15374 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015376hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15377 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15378 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15379 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15380 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015381 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15384 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15385 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15386 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15387 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15388 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15389 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15390 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15391 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15394 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15395 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15396 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15397 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15400 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15401 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15402 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15403 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15404 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15405 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15406 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15407 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015408 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015409 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015410 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015412 ACL derivatives :
15413 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15414 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15415 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15416 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15417 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15418 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15419 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15420 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15421
15422req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15423hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15424 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15425 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15426 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15427 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15428 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15429 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15430 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15431 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15432 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15433
15434req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15435hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15436 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15437 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15438 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15439 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15440 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015441 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15443 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15444
15445req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15446hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15447 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15448 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15449 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15450 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15451 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15452 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15453 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15454
15455http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15456 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15457 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15458 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15459 basic auth is supported.
15460
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015461http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15462 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15463 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15464 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15465 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15467 basic auth is supported.
15468
15469 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015470 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15471 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15472 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15473 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474
15475http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015476 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15477 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15479 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481method : integer + string
15482 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15483 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15484 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15485 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15486 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15487 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15488 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 ACL derivatives :
15491 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493 Example :
15494 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15495 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15496 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498path : string
15499 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15500 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15501 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15502 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15503 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015504 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015505 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 ACL derivatives :
15508 path : exact string match
15509 path_beg : prefix match
15510 path_dir : subdir match
15511 path_dom : domain match
15512 path_end : suffix match
15513 path_len : length match
15514 path_reg : regex match
15515 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015516
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015517query : string
15518 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15519 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15520 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15521 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015522 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015523 which stops before the question mark.
15524
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015525req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15526 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15527 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15528 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15529 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531req.ver : string
15532req_ver : string (deprecated)
15533 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15534 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15535 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 ACL derivatives :
15538 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540res.comp : boolean
15541 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15542 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15543 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545res.comp_algo : string
15546 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15547 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15548 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550res.cook([<name>]) : string
15551scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15552 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15553 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15554 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 ACL derivatives :
15557 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15560scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15561 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15562 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15563 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15566scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15568 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15569 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15573 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15574 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15575 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15576 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15577 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15578 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15579 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15580 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15583 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15584 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15585 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15586 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15587 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15590shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15591 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15592 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15593 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15594 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15595 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15596 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15597 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15598 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600 ACL derivatives :
15601 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15602 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15603 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15604 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15605 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15606 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15607 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15608 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15609
15610res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15611shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15612 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15613 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15614 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15615 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15616 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15619shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15620 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15621 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15622 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15623 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15624 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15625 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015626
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015627res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15628 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15629 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15630 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15631 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15634shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15635 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15636 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15637 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15638 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15639 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15640 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642res.ver : string
15643resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15644 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15645 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 ACL derivatives :
15648 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15651 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15652 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015653 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15657 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659status : integer
15660 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15661 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15662 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015663
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015664unique-id : string
15665 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15666 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15667 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15668 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15669 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15670 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672url : string
15673 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15674 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15675 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15676 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15677 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15678 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15679 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 ACL derivatives :
15682 url : exact string match
15683 url_beg : prefix match
15684 url_dir : subdir match
15685 url_dom : domain match
15686 url_end : suffix match
15687 url_len : length match
15688 url_reg : regex match
15689 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691url_ip : ip
15692 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15693 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15694 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15695 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15696 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15697 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15698 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700url_port : integer
15701 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15702 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15703 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15704 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015705
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015706urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15707url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15709 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015710 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15711 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15712 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15713 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15715 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015716 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15717 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 ACL derivatives :
15720 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15721 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15722 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15723 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15724 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15725 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15726 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15727 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015728
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 Example :
15731 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15732 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15733 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15734 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015735
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015736urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15738 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15739 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015740
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015741url32 : integer
15742 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15743 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15744 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15745 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15746 is an unsigned integer.
15747
15748url32+src : binary
15749 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15750 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15751 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15752
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157547.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015755---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015757Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15758every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015759order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015761ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15762---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015763FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015764HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015765HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15766HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015767HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15768HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15769HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15770HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15771LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015772METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015773METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015774METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15775METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15776METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15777METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015778METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015779METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015780RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015781REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015782TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015783WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15784---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015785
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157878. Logging
15788----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015789
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015790One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15791provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15792very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15793provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15794state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015795to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015796headers.
15797
15798In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15799about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15800send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15801
15802 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15803 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15804 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15805 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15806 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015807 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015808 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015809
15810The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15811allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15812as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15813while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15814real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15815delay.
15816
15817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158188.1. Log levels
15819---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015820
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015821TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015822source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015823HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15824in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15825track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15826syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15827about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015828
15829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158308.2. Log formats
15831----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015832
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015833HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015834and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15835slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15836options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015837
15838 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15839 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15840 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15841 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15842 extents.
15843
15844 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15845 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15846 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15847 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15848 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15849
15850 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15851 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15852 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15853 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15854 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15855
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015856 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15857 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15858 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15859 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15860
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015861 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15862
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015863Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15864specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15865field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15866servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15867always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15868identifier.
15869
15870Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15871 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15872 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15873 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15874 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15875
15876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158778.2.1. Default log format
15878-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015879
15880This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15881as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15882format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15883
15884 Example :
15885 listen www
15886 mode http
15887 log global
15888 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15889
15890 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15891 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15892 (www/HTTP)
15893
15894 Field Format Extract from the example above
15895 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15896 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15897 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15898 4 'to' to
15899 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15900 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15901
15902Detailed fields description :
15903 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15904 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15905 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15906 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15907 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15908 and processed the connection.
15909 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15910
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015911In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15912"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15913connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015915It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15916will eventually disappear.
15917
15918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159198.2.2. TCP log format
15920---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015921
15922The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15923is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15924information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15925counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15926emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15927environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15928the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15929sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015930specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15931not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15932fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15933marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015934
15935 Example :
15936 frontend fnt
15937 mode tcp
15938 option tcplog
15939 log global
15940 default_backend bck
15941
15942 backend bck
15943 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15944
15945 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15946 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15947 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15948
15949 Field Format Extract from the example above
15950 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15951 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15952 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15953 4 frontend_name fnt
15954 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15955 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15956 7 bytes_read* 212
15957 8 termination_state --
15958 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15959 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15960
15961Detailed fields description :
15962 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015963 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15964 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15965 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015966 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015967 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015968 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015969
15970 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015971 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15972 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15973 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015974
15975 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15976 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15977 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020015978 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
15979 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
15980 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
15981 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015982
15983 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15984 and processed the connection.
15985
15986 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15987 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15988 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15989 applications.
15990
15991 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15992 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15993 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15994 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15995 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15996
15997 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15998 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15999 See "Timers" below for more details.
16000
16001 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16002 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16003 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16004 "Timers" below for more details.
16005
16006 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016007 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016008 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16009 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16010 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16011 details.
16012
16013 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16014 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16015 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16016 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16017 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16018
16019 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16020 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16021 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16022 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16023 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16024 for more details.
16025
16026 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016027 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016028 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16029 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16030 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016031 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016032
16033 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16034 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16035 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16036 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16037 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16038 caused by a denial of service attack.
16039
16040 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16041 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16042 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16043 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16044 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16045 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16046 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16047 denial of service attack.
16048
16049 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16050 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16051 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16052 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16053 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16054 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16055 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16056 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16057 be processed than on other servers.
16058
16059 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16060 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16061 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16062 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16063 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16064 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16065 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16066 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16067 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16068 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16069 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16070 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16071 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16072
16073 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16074 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16075 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16076 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16077 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16078 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016079 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016080 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16081
16082 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16083 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16084 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16085 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16086 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16087 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016088 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016089 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16090 occurs.
16091
16092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160938.2.3. HTTP log format
16094----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016095
16096The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16097is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16098the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16099are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16100emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16101generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16102"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16103which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016104frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16105is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016106
16107Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16108slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16109with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16110
16111 Example :
16112 frontend http-in
16113 mode http
16114 option httplog
16115 log global
16116 default_backend bck
16117
16118 backend static
16119 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16120
16121 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16122 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16123 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016124 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016125
16126 Field Format Extract from the example above
16127 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16128 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016129 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016130 4 frontend_name http-in
16131 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016132 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016133 7 status_code 200
16134 8 bytes_read* 2750
16135 9 captured_request_cookie -
16136 10 captured_response_cookie -
16137 11 termination_state ----
16138 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16139 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16140 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16141 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16142 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016144Detailed fields description :
16145 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016146 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16147 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16148 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016149 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016150 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016151 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016152
16153 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016154 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16155 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16156 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016157
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016158 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16159 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016160
16161 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16162 and processed the connection.
16163
16164 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16165 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16166 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16167
16168 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16169 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16170 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16171 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16172 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16173 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16174
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016175 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16176 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16177 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16178 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16179 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16180 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016181 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16182 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016183
16184 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16185 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016186 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016187
16188 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16189 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016190 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16191 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016192
16193 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16194 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16195 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16196 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16197 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016198 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16199 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016200
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016201 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16202 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16203 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16204 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16205 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16206 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16207 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016208 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016209
16210 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16211 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16212 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16213
16214 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16215 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16216 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16217 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16218 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16219 overflowing.
16220
16221 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16222 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16223 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16224 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16225 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16226 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16227 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16228 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16229
16230 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16231 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16232 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16233 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16234 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16235 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16236 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16237 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16238
16239 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16240 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16241 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16242 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16243 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16244 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16245 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16246
16247 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016248 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016249 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16250 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16251 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016252 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016253 system.
16254
16255 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16256 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16257 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16258 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16259 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16260 caused by a denial of service attack.
16261
16262 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16263 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16264 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16265 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16266 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16267 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16268 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16269 denial of service attack.
16270
16271 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16272 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16273 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16274 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16275 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16276 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16277 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16278 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16279 processed than on other servers.
16280
16281 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16282 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16283 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16284 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16285 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16286 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16287 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16288 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16289 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16290 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16291 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16292 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16293 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16294
16295 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16296 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16297 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16298 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16299 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16300 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016301 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016302 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16303
16304 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16305 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16306 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16307 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16308 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16309 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016310 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016311 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16312 occurs.
16313
16314 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16315 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16316 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16317 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16318 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16319 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16320 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16321 cookies" below for more details.
16322
16323 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16324 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16325 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16326 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16327 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16328 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16329 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16330 and cookies" below for more details.
16331
16332 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16333 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16334 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16335 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16336 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16337 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16338 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16339 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16340
16341
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200163428.2.4. Custom log format
16343------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016344
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016345The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016346mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016347
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016348HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016349Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16350separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16351prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16352
16353Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16354variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016355("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016356
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016357If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016358as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016359less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16360the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16361
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016362Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016363In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016364in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016365
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016366Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16367'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16368https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16369such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16370
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016371Flags are :
16372 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016373 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016374 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16375 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016376
16377 Example:
16378
16379 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16380 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16381
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016382 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16383
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016384At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16385
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016386 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16387 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016388
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016389the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016390
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016391 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16392 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16393 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016394
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016395and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16396
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016397 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16398 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016399
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016400Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16401
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016402 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016403 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016404 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16405 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16406 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016407 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16408 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16409 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016410 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016411 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16412 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016413 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016414 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16415 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016416 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016417 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016418 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016419 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016420 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016421 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016422 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016423 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16424 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16425 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16426 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16427 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016428 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016429 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16430 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016431 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016432 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16433 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016434 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16435 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16436 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016437 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016438 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16439 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016440 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016441 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16442 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16443 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016444 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016445 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016446 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16447 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16448 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16449 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016450 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016451 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016452 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016453 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016454 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016455 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016456 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16457 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16458 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016459 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016460 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16461 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016462 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016463 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16464 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016465 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016466 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016467 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016468 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016469
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016470 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016471
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016472
164738.2.5. Error log format
16474-----------------------
16475
16476When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16477protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16478By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16479"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016480will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016481logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16482
16483The format looks like this :
16484
16485 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16486 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16487 Connection error during SSL handshake
16488
16489 Field Format Extract from the example above
16490 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16491 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16492 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16493 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16494 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16495
16496These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16497failures.
16498
16499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165008.3. Advanced logging options
16501-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016502
16503Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16504just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16505options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16506for more information about their usage.
16507
16508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165098.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16510------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016511
16512It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16513haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16514commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16515monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16516ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16517
16518 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16519 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16520 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16521 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16522
16523 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16524 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16525 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016526 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016527 such as other load-balancers.
16528
16529 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16530 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16531 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16532
16533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165348.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16535----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016536
16537The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16538what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16539or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016540"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16542log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16543after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16544is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16545with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16546with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16547
16548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165498.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16550------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016551
16552Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16553for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16554"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16555retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16556raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16557a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16558file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16559you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16560"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16561
16562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165638.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16564--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016565
16566Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16567multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16568them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16569"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16570logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16571error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16572and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16573too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16574useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16575alternative.
16576
16577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165788.4. Timing events
16579------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016580
16581Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16582reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16583the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16584frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016585mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16586addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16587
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016588Timings events in HTTP mode:
16589
16590 first request 2nd request
16591 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16592 t tr t tr ...
16593 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16594 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16595 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16596 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16597 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16598
16599Timings events in TCP mode:
16600
16601 TCP session
16602 |<----------------->|
16603 t t
16604 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16605 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16606 |<------ Tt ------->|
16607
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016608 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016610 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16611 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16612 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016613 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016614 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
16615 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
16616 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
16617 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016618
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016619 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16620 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16621 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016622 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
16623 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
16624 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
16625 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
16626 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
16627 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016628
16629 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16630 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16631 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16632 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16633 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16634 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16635 request typed by hand during a test.
16636
16637 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16638 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016639 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016640 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16641 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16642 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16643 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016644
16645 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16646 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16647 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16648 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16649 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16650
16651 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16652 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16653 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16654 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16655 connection never established.
16656
16657 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16658 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16659 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16660 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16661 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16662 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16663 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16664 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16665 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16666 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16667 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016669 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16670 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16671 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16672 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16673 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16674 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16675
16676 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16677
16678 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16679 "Ta" can never be negative.
16680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16682 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016683 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16684 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016685 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016687 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688
16689 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016690 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16691 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016692
16693These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16694protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16695that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016696due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16697"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16698that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016699
16700Most common cases :
16701
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016702 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16703 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16704 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16705 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16706 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16707 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16708 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16709 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16710 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16711 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16712 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016713 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016714
16715 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16716 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16717 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16718 of ms on remote networks.
16719
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016720 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16721 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16722 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016723
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016724 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16725 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16726 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16727 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16728 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16729 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16730 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16731 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16732 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733
16734Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16735
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016736 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016737 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016738 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016740 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016741 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16742 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16743
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016744 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016745 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16746 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16747 flags.
16748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016749 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16750 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016751 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16752 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16753 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16754 the client connection was maintained open.
16755
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016756 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016757 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016758 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016759 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16760
16761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167628.5. Session state at disconnection
16763-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016764
16765TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16766"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
167672-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16768each of which has a special meaning :
16769
16770 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16771 session to terminate :
16772
16773 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16774
16775 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16776 server explicitly refused it.
16777
16778 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16779 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16780 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16781 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016782 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016783
16784 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16785 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016786
16787 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16788 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16789 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16790 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16791 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16792
16793 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16794 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16795 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16796 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16797 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16798
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016799 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16800 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16801
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016802 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16803 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16804 backup connections when going up.
16805
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016806 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16807
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016808 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16809 send or receive data.
16810
16811 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16812 send or receive data.
16813
16814 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16815 with nothing left in the buffers.
16816
16817 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16818
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016819 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016820 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16821
16822 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16823 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16824 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16825 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16826 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16827
16828 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16829 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16830
16831 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16832 server (HTTP only).
16833
16834 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16835
16836 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16837 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16838 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16839
16840 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16841 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16842 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16843
16844 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16845
16846 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16847 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16848
16849 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16850 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16851 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16852
16853 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16854 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016855 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16856 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016857
16858 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16859 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16860 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16861 another server.
16862
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016863 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016864 server.
16865
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016866 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16867 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16868 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16869 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16870
16871 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16872 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16873 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16874 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16875
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016876 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16877 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16878 "use-server" rule).
16879
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016880 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16881
16882 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16883 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16884
16885 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16886
16887 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16888 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16889 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16890
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016891 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16892 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016893 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016894 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16895 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16896
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016897 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16898
16899 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16900 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16901
16902 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16903
16904 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16905
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016906The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16907was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016908helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16909starvation, attacks, etc...
16910
16911The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16912alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16913easier finding and understanding.
16914
16915 Flags Reason
16916
16917 -- Normal termination.
16918
16919 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16920 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16921 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16922 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16923
16924 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16925 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16926 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16927 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16928 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16929 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016930
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016931 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16932 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016933 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016934
16935 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16936 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16937 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16938
16939 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16940 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16941 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16942 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16943 the server takes too long to respond.
16944
16945 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16946 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16947 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16948 long a time to respond.
16949
16950 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16951 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16952 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16953 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016954 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16955 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016956
16957 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16958 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16959 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16960 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16961 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016962 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016963 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16964 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16965 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16966 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16967 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16968 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16969 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16970 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016971 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016972 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16973 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16974 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16977 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016978 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16979 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16980 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16981 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016982
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016983 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16984 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016986 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016987 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16988 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016989 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16991 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16992
16993 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16994 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16995 503 or 504 here.
16996
16997 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16998 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16999 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17000 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17001 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17002
17003 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17004 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017005 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17007 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17008
17009 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17010 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17011 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17012 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17013 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17014 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17015 between haproxy and the server.
17016
17017 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17018 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17019 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17020 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17021 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17022 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17023 solution is to fix the application.
17024
17025 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17026 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17027 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17028 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17029 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17030 external attacks.
17031
17032 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17033 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017034 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017035 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17036 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17037
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017038 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17039 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17040 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017041 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017042 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017043
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17045 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17046 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17047 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017048 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17049 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17050 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17051 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17052 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017053
17054 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17055 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17056 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17057 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17058
17059 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17060 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17061 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17062 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17063
17064 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17065 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17066 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17067 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17068
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017069The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17070persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17071important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17072re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17073
17074 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17075
17076 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17077 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17078 set on a GET request.
17079
17080 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17081 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017082 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017083 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17084
17085 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17086 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17087 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17088
17089 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17090 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17091 already got a cookie.
17092
17093 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17094 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17095 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17096 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17097 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17098
17099 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17100 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17101 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17102
17103 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17104 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17105 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17106
17107 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17108 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17109
17110 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17111 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17112 then advertised in the response.
17113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171158.6. Non-printable characters
17116-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017117
17118In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17119consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17120converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17121prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17122being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17123escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17124is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17125'}' when logging headers.
17126
17127Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17128issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17129containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17130
17131Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17132the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17133performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17134
17135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171368.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17137---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138
17139Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17140achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017141section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017142cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17143the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17144the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017145locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017146not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17147user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17148a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17149wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17150
17151 Examples :
17152 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17153 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17154
17155 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17156 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17157
17158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171598.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17160---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161
17162Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17163proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17164the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17165server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17166
17167Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17168response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017169section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017170
17171It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017172time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17173appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17175and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17176follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17177request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17178in the logs.
17179
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017180As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17181frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17182an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17183
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017184 Example :
17185 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17186 listen proxy-out
17187 mode http
17188 option httplog
17189 option logasap
17190 log global
17191 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17192
17193 # log the name of the virtual server
17194 capture request header Host len 20
17195
17196 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17197 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17198
17199 # log the beginning of the referrer
17200 capture request header Referer len 20
17201
17202 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17203 capture response header Server len 20
17204
17205 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17206 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017208 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017209 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17210
17211 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17212 capture response header Via len 20
17213
17214 # log the URL location during a redirection
17215 capture response header Location len 20
17216
17217 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17218 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17219 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17220 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17221 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17222
17223 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17224 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17225 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17226 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017227 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228
17229 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17230 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17231 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17232 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17233 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017234 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017235
17236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172378.9. Examples of logs
17238---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017239
17240These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17241them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17242reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17243
17244 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17245 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17246 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17247
17248 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17249 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17250
17251 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17252 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17253 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17254
17255 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17256 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17257
17258 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17259 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17260 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17261
17262 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017263 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17265 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17266
17267 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17268 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17269 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17270
17271 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17272 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017273 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17275 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17276 to return the 502 and not the server.
17277
17278 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017279 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280
17281 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17282 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17283 Nothing was sent to any server.
17284
17285 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17286 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17287
17288 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17289 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017290 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017291 send a 408 return code to the client.
17292
17293 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17294 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17295
17296 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17297 5 seconds ("c----").
17298
17299 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17300 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017301 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017302
17303 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017304 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017305 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17306 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17307 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17308 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17309 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017310
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017311
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200173129. Supported filters
17313--------------------
17314
17315Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17316accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17317unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17318
17319See also : "filter"
17320
173219.1. Trace
17322----------
17323
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017324filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017325
17326 Arguments:
17327 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17328 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17329
17330 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17331 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17332 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17333 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17334
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017335 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017336 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17337 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17338 amount of the parsed data.
17339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017340 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017341
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017342This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17343callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17344information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17345filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17346
17347Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17348tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17349a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17350
17351
173529.2. HTTP compression
17353---------------------
17354
17355filter compression
17356
17357The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17358keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
17359when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
17360use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
17361used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
17362filters evaluation order.
17363
17364See also : "compression"
17365
17366
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200173679.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17368--------------------------------------------
17369
17370filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17371
17372 Arguments :
17373
17374 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17375 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17376 parsed.
17377
17378 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17379 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17380 part must be placed in its own scope.
17381
17382The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17383external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017384streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017385exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17386also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17387
17388SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17389the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17390
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017391For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017392"doc/SPOE.txt".
17393
17394Important note:
17395 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17396 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17397
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001739810. Cache
17399---------
17400
17401HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17402(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17403RAM.
17404
17405The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017406this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017407
17408If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17409independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17410when we try to allocate a new one.
17411
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017412The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017413
17414It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17415"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17416for more details.
17417
17418When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17419replaced by "<CACHE>".
17420
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001742110.1. Limitation
17422----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017423
17424The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17425
17426- If the response is not a 200
17427- If the response contains a Vary header
17428- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17429 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17430 reserve.
17431- If the response is not cacheable
17432
17433- If the request is not a GET
17434- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017435- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017436
17437Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17438to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017439if they modify the response (compression for example).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017440
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001744110.2. Setup
17442-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017443
17444To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17445the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17446
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001744710.2.1. Cache section
17448---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017449
17450cache <name>
17451 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17452 size of cache is mandatory.
17453
17454total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017455 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17456 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017457
17458max-age <seconds>
17459 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17460 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17461 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17462 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17463 default.
17464
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001746510.2.2. Proxy section
17466---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017467
17468http-request cache-use <name>
17469 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17470 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17471 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17472 after this one.
17473
17474http-response cache-store <name>
17475 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17476 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17477 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17478 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17479
17480
17481Example:
17482
17483 backend bck1
17484 mode http
17485
17486 http-request cache-use foobar
17487 http-response cache-store foobar
17488 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17489
17490 cache foobar
17491 total-max-size 4
17492 max-age 240
17493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017494/*
17495 * Local variables:
17496 * fill-column: 79
17497 * End:
17498 */